annotate runtime/doc/options.txt @ 515:04dcb5a1f2f9

updated for version 7.0144
author vimboss
date Fri, 09 Sep 2005 19:49:30 +0000
parents 52e76e2b5b65
children d50452846776
Ignore whitespace changes - Everywhere: Within whitespace: At end of lines:
rev   line source
515
04dcb5a1f2f9 updated for version 7.0144
vimboss
parents: 502
diff changeset
1 *options.txt* For Vim version 7.0aa. Last change: 2005 Sep 08
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7 Options *options*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
9 1. Setting options |set-option|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
10 2. Automatically setting options |auto-setting|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
11 3. Options summary |option-summary|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
12
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
13 For an overview of options see help.txt |option-list|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
14
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
15 Vim has a number of internal variables and switches which can be set to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
16 achieve special effects. These options come in three forms:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
17 boolean can only be on or off *boolean* *toggle*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
18 number has a numeric value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
19 string has a string value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
20
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
21 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
22 1. Setting options *set-option*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
23
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
24 *:se* *:set*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
25 :se[t] Show all options that differ from their default value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
26
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
27 :se[t] all Show all but terminal options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
28
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
29 :se[t] termcap Show all terminal options. Note that in the GUI the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
30 key codes are not shown, because they are generated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
31 internally and can't be changed. Changing the terminal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
32 codes in the GUI is not useful either...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
33
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
34 *E518* *E519*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
35 :se[t] {option}? Show value of {option}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
36
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
37 :se[t] {option} Toggle option: set, switch it on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
38 Number option: show value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
39 String option: show value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
40
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
41 :se[t] no{option} Toggle option: Reset, switch it off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
42
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
43 :se[t] {option}! or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
44 :se[t] inv{option} Toggle option: Invert value. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
45
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
46 *:set-default* *:set-&* *:set-&vi* *:set-&vim*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
47 :se[t] {option}& Reset option to its default value. May depend on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
48 current value of 'compatible'. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
49 :se[t] {option}&vi Reset option to its Vi default value. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
50 :se[t] {option}&vim Reset option to its Vim default value. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
51
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
52 :se[t] all& Set all options, except terminal options, to their
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
53 default value. The values of 'term', 'lines' and
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
54 'columns' are not changed. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
55
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
56 *:set-args* *E487* *E521*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
57 :se[t] {option}={value} or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
58 :se[t] {option}:{value}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
59 Set string or number option to {value}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
60 For numeric options the value can be given in decimal,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
61 hex (preceded with 0x) or octal (preceded with '0')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
62 (hex and octal are only available for machines which
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
63 have the strtol() function).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
64 The old value can be inserted by typing 'wildchar' (by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
65 default this is a <Tab> or CTRL-E if 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
66 set). See |cmdline-completion|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
67 White space between {option} and '=' is allowed and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
68 will be ignored. White space between '=' and {value}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
69 is not allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
70 See |option-backslash| for using white space and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
71 backslashes in {value}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
72
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
73 :se[t] {option}+={value} *:set+=*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
74 Add the {value} to a number option, or append the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
75 {value} to a string option. When the option is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
76 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
77 value was empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
78 If the option is a list of flags, superfluous flags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
79 are removed. Otherwise there is no check for doubled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
80 values. You can avoid this by removing a value first.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
81 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
82 :set guioptions-=T guioptions+=T
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
83 < Also see |:set-args| above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
84 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
85
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
86 :se[t] {option}^={value} *:set^=*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
87 Multiply the {value} to a number option, or prepend
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
88 the {value} to a string option. When the option is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
89 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
90 value was empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
91 Also see |:set-args| above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
92 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
93
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
94 :se[t] {option}-={value} *:set-=*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
95 Subtract the {value} from a number option, or remove
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
96 the {value} from a string option, if it is there.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
97 If the {value} is not found in a string option, there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
98 is no error or warning. When the option is a comma
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
99 separated list, a comma is deleted, unless the option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
100 becomes empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
101 When the option is a list of flags, {value} must be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
102 exactly as they appear in the option. Remove flags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
103 one by one to avoid problems.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
104 Also see |:set-args| above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
105 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
106
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
107 The {option} arguments to ":set" may be repeated. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
108 :set ai nosi sw=3 ts=3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
109 If you make an error in one of the arguments, an error message will be given
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
110 and the following arguments will be ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
111
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
112 *:set-verbose*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
113 When 'verbose' is non-zero, displaying an option value will also tell where it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
114 was last set. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
115 :verbose set shiftwidth cindent?
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
116 shiftwidth=4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
117 Last set from modeline
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
118 cindent
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
119 Last set from /usr/local/share/vim/vim60/ftplugin/c.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
120 This is only done when specific option values are requested, not for ":set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
121 all" or ":set" without an argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
122 When the option was set by hand there is no "Last set" message. There is only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
123 one value for all local options with the same name. Thus the message applies
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
124 to the option name, not necessarily its value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
125 When the option was set while executing a function, user command or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
126 autocommand, the script in which it was defined is reported.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
127 Note that an option may also have been set as a side effect of setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
128 'compatible'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
129 {not available when compiled without the +eval feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
130
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
131 *:set-termcap* *E522*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
132 For {option} the form "t_xx" may be used to set a termcap option. This will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
133 override the value from the termcap. You can then use it in a mapping. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
134 the "xx" part contains special characters, use the <t_xx> form: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
135 :set <t_#4>=^[Ot
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
136 This can also be used to translate a special code for a normal key. For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
137 example, if Alt-b produces <Esc>b, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
138 :set <M-b>=^[b
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
139 (the ^[ is a real <Esc> here, use CTRL-V <Esc> to enter it)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
140 The advantage over a mapping is that it works in all situations.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
141
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
142 The t_xx options cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
143 security reasons.
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
144
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
145 The listing from ":set" looks different from Vi. Long string options are put
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
146 at the end of the list. The number of options is quite large. The output of
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
147 "set all" probably does not fit on the screen, causing Vim to give the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
148 |more-prompt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
149
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
150 *option-backslash*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
151 To include white space in a string option value it has to be preceded with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
152 backslash. To include a backslash you have to use two. Effectively this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
153 means that the number of backslashes in an option value is halved (rounded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
154 down).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
155 A few examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
156 :set tags=tags\ /usr/tags results in "tags /usr/tags"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
157 :set tags=tags\\,file results in "tags\,file"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
158 :set tags=tags\\\ file results in "tags\ file"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
159
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
160 The "|" character separates a ":set" command from a following command. To
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
161 include the "|" in the option value, use "\|" instead. This example sets the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
162 'titlestring' option to "hi|there": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
163 :set titlestring=hi\|there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
164 This sets the 'titlestring' option to "hi" and 'iconstring' to "there": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
165 :set titlestring=hi|set iconstring=there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
166
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
167 For MS-DOS and WIN32 backslashes in file names are mostly not removed. More
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
168 precise: For options that expect a file name (those where environment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
169 variables are expanded) a backslash before a normal file name character is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
170 removed. But a backslash before a special character (space, backslash, comma,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
171 etc.) is used like explained above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
172 There is one special situation, when the value starts with "\\": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
173 :set dir=\\machine\path results in "\\machine\path"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
174 :set dir=\\\\machine\\path results in "\\machine\path"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
175 :set dir=\\path\\file results in "\\path\file" (wrong!)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
176 For the first one the start is kept, but for the second one the backslashes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
177 are halved. This makes sure it works both when you expect backslashes to be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
178 halved and when you expect the backslashes to be kept. The third gives a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
179 result which is probably not what you want. Avoid it.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
180
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
181 *add-option-flags* *remove-option-flags*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
182 *E539* *E550* *E551* *E552*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
183 Some options are a list of flags. When you want to add a flag to such an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
184 option, without changing the existing ones, you can do it like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
185 :set guioptions+=a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
186 Remove a flag from an option like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
187 :set guioptions-=a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
188 This removes the 'a' flag from 'guioptions'.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
189 Note that you should add or remove one flag at a time. If 'guioptions' has
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
190 the value "ab", using "set guioptions-=ba" won't work, because the string "ba"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
191 doesn't appear.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
192
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
193 *:set_env* *expand-env* *expand-environment-var*
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 20
diff changeset
194 Environment variables in specific string options will be expanded. If the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
195 environment variable exists the '$' and the following environment variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
196 name is replaced with its value. If it does not exist the '$' and the name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
197 are not modified. Any non-id character (not a letter, digit or '_') may
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
198 follow the environment variable name. That character and what follows is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
199 appended to the value of the environment variable. Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
200 :set term=$TERM.new
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
201 :set path=/usr/$INCLUDE,$HOME/include,.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
202 When adding or removing a string from an option with ":set opt-=val" or ":set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
203 opt+=val" the expansion is done before the adding or removing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
204
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
205
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
206 Handling of local options *local-options*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
207
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
208 Some of the options only apply to a window or buffer. Each window or buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
209 has its own copy of this option, thus can each have their own value. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
210 allows you to set 'list' in one window but not in another. And set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
211 'shiftwidth' to 3 in one buffer and 4 in another.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
212
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
213 The following explains what happens to these local options in specific
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
214 situations. You don't really need to know all of this, since Vim mostly uses
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
215 the option values you would expect. Unfortunately, doing what the user
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
216 expects is a bit complicated...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
217
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
218 When splitting a window, the local options are copied to the new window. Thus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
219 right after the split the contents of the two windows look the same.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
220
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
221 When editing a new buffer, its local option values must be initialized. Since
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
222 the local options of the current buffer might be specifically for that buffer,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
223 these are not used. Instead, for each buffer-local option there also is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
224 global value, which is used for new buffers. With ":set" both the local and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
225 global value is changed. With "setlocal" only the local value is changed,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
226 thus this value is not used when editing a new buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
227
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
228 When editing a buffer that has been edited before, the last used window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
229 options are used again. If this buffer has been edited in this window, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
230 values from back then are used. Otherwise the values from the window where
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
231 the buffer was edited last are used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
232
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
233 It's possible to set a local window option specifically for a type of buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
234 When you edit another buffer in the same window, you don't want to keep
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
235 using these local window options. Therefore Vim keeps a global value of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
236 local window options, which is used when editing another buffer. Each window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
237 has its own copy of these values. Thus these are local to the window, but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
238 global to all buffers in the window. With this you can do: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
239 :e one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
240 :set list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
241 :e two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
242 Now the 'list' option will also be set in "two", since with the ":set list"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
243 command you have also set the global value. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
244 :set nolist
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
245 :e one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
246 :setlocal list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
247 :e two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
248 Now the 'list' option is not set, because ":set nolist" resets the global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
249 value, ":setlocal list" only changes the local value and ":e two" gets the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
250 global value. Note that if you do this next: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
251 :e one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
252 You will not get back the 'list' value as it was the last time you edited
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
253 "one". The options local to a window are not remembered for each buffer.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
254
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
255 *:setl* *:setlocal*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
256 :setl[ocal] ... Like ":set" but set only the value local to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
257 current buffer or window. Not all options have a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
258 local value. If the option does not have a local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
259 value the global value is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
260 With the "all" argument: display all local option's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
261 local values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
262 Without argument: Display all local option's local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
263 values which are different from the default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
264 When displaying a specific local option, show the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
265 local value. For a global option the global value is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
266 shown (but that might change in the future).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
267 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
268
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
269 :setl[ocal] {option}< Set the local value of {option} to its global value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
270 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
271
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
272 *:setg* *:setglobal*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
273 :setg[lobal] ... Like ":set" but set only the global value for a local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
274 option without changing the local value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
275 When displaying an option, the global value is shown.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
276 With the "all" argument: display all local option's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
277 global values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
278 Without argument: display all local option's global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
279 values which are different from the default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
280 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
281
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
282 For buffer-local and window-local options:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
283 Command global value local value ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
284 :set option=value set set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
285 :setlocal option=value - set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
286 :setglobal option=value set -
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
287 :set option? - display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
288 :setlocal option? - display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
289 :setglobal option? display -
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
290
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
291
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
292 Global options with a local value *global-local*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
293
40
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
294 Options are global when you mostly use one value for all buffers and windows.
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
295 For some global options it's useful to sometimes have a different local value.
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
296 You can set the local value with ":setlocal". That buffer or window will then
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
297 use the local value, while other buffers and windows continue using the global
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
298 value.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
299
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
300 For example, you have two windows, both on C source code. They use the global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
301 'makeprg' option. If you do this in one of the two windows: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
302 :set makeprg=gmake
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
303 then the other window will switch to the same value. There is no need to set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
304 the 'makeprg' option in the other C source window too.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
305 However, if you start editing a Perl file in a new window, you want to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
306 another 'makeprog' for it, without changing the value used for the C source
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
307 files. You use this command: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
308 :setlocal makeprg=perlmake
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
309 You can switch back to using the global value by making the local value empty: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
310 :setlocal makeprg=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
311 This only works for a string option. For a boolean option you need to use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
312 "<" flag, like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
313 :setlocal autoread<
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
314 Note that for non-boolean options using "<" copies the global value to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
315 local value, it doesn't switch back to using the global value (that matters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
316 when changing the global value later).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
317 Note: In the future more global options can be made global-local. Using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
318 ":setlocal" on a global option might work differently then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
319
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
320
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
321 Setting the filetype
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
322
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
323 :setf[iletype] {filetype} *:setf* *:setfiletype*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
324 Set the 'filetype' option to {filetype}, but only if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
325 not done yet in a sequence of (nested) autocommands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
326 This is short for: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
327 :if !did_filetype()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
328 : setlocal filetype={filetype}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
329 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
330 < This command is used in a filetype.vim file to avoid
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
331 setting the 'filetype' option twice, causing different
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
332 settings and syntax files to be loaded.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
333 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
334
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
335 :bro[wse] se[t] *:set-browse* *:browse-set* *:opt* *:options*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
336 :opt[ions] Open a window for viewing and setting all options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
337 Options are grouped by function.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
338 Offers short help for each option. Hit <CR> on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
339 short help to open a help window with more help for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
340 the option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
341 Modify the value of the option and hit <CR> on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
342 "set" line to set the new value. For window and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
343 buffer specific options, the last accessed window is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
344 used to set the option value in, unless this is a help
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
345 window, in which case the window below help window is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
346 used (skipping the option-window).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
347 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
348 |+autocmd| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
349
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
350 *$HOME*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
351 Using "~" is like using "$HOME", but it is only recognized at the start of an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
352 option and after a space or comma.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
353
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
354 On Unix systems "~user" can be used too. It is replaced by the home directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
355 of user "user". Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
356 :set path=~mool/include,/usr/include,.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
357
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
358 On Unix systems the form "${HOME}" can be used too. The name between {} can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
359 contain non-id characters then. Note that if you want to use this for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
360 "gf" command, you need to add the '{' and '}' characters to 'isfname'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
361
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
362 NOTE: expanding environment variables and "~/" is only done with the ":set"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
363 command, not when assigning a value to an option with ":let".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
364
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
365
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
366 Note the maximum length of an expanded option is limited. How much depends on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
367 the system, mostly it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
368
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
369 *:fix* *:fixdel*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
370 :fix[del] Set the value of 't_kD':
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
371 't_kb' is 't_kD' becomes ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
372 CTRL-? CTRL-H
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
373 not CTRL-? CTRL-?
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
374
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
375 (CTRL-? is 0177 octal, 0x7f hex) {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
376
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
377 If your delete key terminal code is wrong, but the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
378 code for backspace is alright, you can put this in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
379 your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
380 :fixdel
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
381 < This works no matter what the actual code for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
382 backspace is.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
383
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
384 If the backspace key terminal code is wrong you can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
385 use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
386 :if &term == "termname"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
387 : set t_kb=^V<BS>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
388 : fixdel
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
389 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
390 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<BS>" is the backspace key
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
391 (don't type four characters!). Replace "termname"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
392 with your terminal name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
393
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
394 If your <Delete> key sends a strange key sequence (not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
395 CTRL-? or CTRL-H) you cannot use ":fixdel". Then use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
396 :if &term == "termname"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
397 : set t_kD=^V<Delete>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
398 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
399 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<Delete>" is the delete key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
400 (don't type eight characters!). Replace "termname"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
401 with your terminal name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
402
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
403 *Linux-backspace*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
404 Note about Linux: By default the backspace key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
405 produces CTRL-?, which is wrong. You can fix it by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
406 putting this line in your rc.local: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
407 echo "keycode 14 = BackSpace" | loadkeys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
408 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
409 *NetBSD-backspace*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
410 Note about NetBSD: If your backspace doesn't produce
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
411 the right code, try this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
412 xmodmap -e "keycode 22 = BackSpace"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
413 < If this works, add this in your .Xmodmap file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
414 keysym 22 = BackSpace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
415 < You need to restart for this to take effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
416
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
417 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
418 2. Automatically setting options *auto-setting*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
419
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
420 Besides changing options with the ":set" command, there are three alternatives
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
421 to set options automatically for one or more files:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
422
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
423 1. When starting Vim initializations are read from various places. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
424 |initialization|. Most of them are performed for all editing sessions,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
425 and some of them depend on the directory where Vim is started.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
426 You can create an initialization file with |:mkvimrc|, |:mkview| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
427 |:mksession|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
428 2. If you start editing a new file, the automatic commands are executed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
429 This can be used to set options for files matching a particular pattern and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
430 many other things. See |autocommand|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
431 3. If you start editing a new file, and the 'modeline' option is on, a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
432 number of lines at the beginning and end of the file are checked for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
433 modelines. This is explained here.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
434
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
435 *modeline* *vim:* *vi:* *ex:* *E520*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
436 There are two forms of modelines. The first form:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
437 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]{options}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
438
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
439 [text] any text or empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
440 {white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
441 {vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
442 [white] optional white space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
443 {options} a list of option settings, separated with white space or ':',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
444 where each part between ':' is the argument for a ":set"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
445 command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
446
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
447 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
448 vi:noai:sw=3 ts=6
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
449
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
450 The second form (this is compatible with some versions of Vi):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
451
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
452 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]se[t] {options}:[text]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
453
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
454 [text] any text or empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
455 {white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
456 {vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
457 [white] optional white space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
458 se[t] the string "set " or "se " (note the space)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
459 {options} a list of options, separated with white space, which is the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
460 argument for a ":set" command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
461 : a colon
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
462 [text] any text or empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
463
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
464 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
465 /* vim: set ai tw=75: */
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
466
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
467 The white space before {vi:|vim:|ex:} is required. This minimizes the chance
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
468 that a normal word like "lex:" is caught. There is one exception: "vi:" and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
469 "vim:" can also be at the start of the line (for compatibility with version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
470 3.0). Using "ex:" at the start of the line will be ignored (this could be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
471 short for "example:").
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
472
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
473 *modeline-local*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
474 The options are set like with ":setlocal": The new value only applies to the
11
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
475 buffer and window that contain the file. Although it's possible to set global
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
476 options from a modeline, this is unusual. If you have two windows open and
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
477 the files in it set the same global option to a different value, the result
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
478 depends on which one was opened last.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
479
23
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
480 When editing a file that was already loaded, only the window-local options
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
481 from the modeline are used. Thus if you manually changed a buffer-local
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
482 option after opening the file, it won't be changed if you edit the same buffer
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
483 in another window. But window-local options will be set.
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
484
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
485 *modeline-version*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
486 If the modeline is only to be used for some versions of Vim, the version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
487 number can be specified where "vim:" is used:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
488 vim{vers}: version {vers} or later
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
489 vim<{vers}: version before {vers}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
490 vim={vers}: version {vers}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
491 vim>{vers}: version after {vers}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
492 {vers} is 600 for Vim 6.0 (hundred times the major version plus minor).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
493 For example, to use a modeline only for Vim 6.0 and later: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
494 /* vim600: set foldmethod=marker: */
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
495 To use a modeline for Vim before version 5.7: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
496 /* vim<570: set sw=4: */
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
497 There can be no blanks between "vim" and the ":".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
498
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
499
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
500 The number of lines that are checked can be set with the 'modelines' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
501 If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is 0 no lines are checked.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
502
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
503 Note that for the first form all of the rest of the line is used, thus a line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
504 like: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
505 /* vi:ts=4: */
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
506 will give an error message for the trailing "*/". This line is OK: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
507 /* vi:set ts=4: */
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
508
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
509 If an error is detected the rest of the line is skipped.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
510
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
511 If you want to include a ':' in a set command precede it with a '\'. The
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
512 backslash in front of the ':' will be removed. Example: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
513 /* vi:set dir=c\:\tmp: */
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
514 This sets the 'dir' option to "c:\tmp". Only a single backslash before the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
515 ':' is removed. Thus to include "\:" you have to specify "\\:".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
516
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
517 No other commands than "set" are supported, for security reasons (somebody
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
518 might create a Trojan horse text file with modelines).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
519
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
520 Hint: If you would like to do something else than setting an option, you could
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
521 define an autocommand that checks the file for a specific string. For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
522 example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
523 au BufReadPost * if getline(1) =~ "VAR" | call SetVar() | endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
524 And define a function SetVar() that does something with the line containing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
525 "VAR".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
526
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
527 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
528 3. Options summary *option-summary*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
529
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
530 In the list below all the options are mentioned with their full name and with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
531 an abbreviation if there is one. Both forms may be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
532
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
533 In this document when a boolean option is "set" that means that ":set option"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
534 is entered. When an option is "reset", ":set nooption" is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
535
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
536 For some options there are two default values: The "Vim default", which is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
537 used when 'compatible' is not set, and the "Vi default", which is used when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
538 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
539
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
540 Most options are the same in all windows and buffers. There are a few that
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
541 are specific to how the text is presented in a window. These can be set to a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
542 different value in each window. For example the 'list' option can be set in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
543 one window and reset in another for the same text, giving both types of view
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
544 at the same time. There are a few options that are specific to a certain
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
545 file. These can have a different value for each file or buffer. For example
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
546 the 'textwidth' option can be 78 for a normal text file and 0 for a C
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
547 program.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
548
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
549 global one option for all buffers and windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
550 local to window each window has its own copy of this option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
551 local to buffer each buffer has its own copy of this option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
552
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
553 When creating a new window the option values from the currently active window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
554 are used as a default value for the window-specific options. For the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
555 buffer-specific options this depends on the 's' and 'S' flags in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
556 'cpoptions' option. If 's' is included (which is the default) the values for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
557 buffer options are copied from the currently active buffer when a buffer is
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
558 first entered. If 'S' is present the options are copied each time the buffer
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
559 is entered, this is almost like having global options. If 's' and 'S' are not
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
560 present, the options are copied from the currently active buffer when the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
561 buffer is created.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
562
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
563 Not all options are supported in all versions. To test if option "foo" can be
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
564 used with ":set" use "exists('&foo')". This doesn't mean the value is
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
565 actually remembered and works. Some options are hidden, which means that you
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
566 can set them but the value is not remembered. To test if option "foo" is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
567 really supported use "exists('+foo')".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
568
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
569 *E355*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
570 A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
571
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
572 *'aleph'* *'al'* *aleph* *Aleph*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
573 'aleph' 'al' number (default 128 for MS-DOS, 224 otherwise)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
574 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
575 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
576 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
577 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
578 The ASCII code for the first letter of the Hebrew alphabet. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
579 routine that maps the keyboard in Hebrew mode, both in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
580 (when hkmap is set) and on the command-line (when hitting CTRL-_)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
581 outputs the Hebrew characters in the range [aleph..aleph+26].
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
582 aleph=128 applies to PC code, and aleph=224 applies to ISO 8859-8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
583 See |rileft.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
584
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
585 *'allowrevins'* *'ari'* *'noallowrevins'* *'noari'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
586 'allowrevins' 'ari' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
587 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
588 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
589 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
590 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
591 Allow CTRL-_ in Insert and Command-line mode. This is default off, to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
592 avoid that users that accidentally type CTRL-_ instead of SHIFT-_ get
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
593 into reverse Insert mode, and don't know how to get out. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
594 'revins'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
595 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
596
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
597 *'altkeymap'* *'akm'* *'noaltkeymap'* *'noakm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
598 'altkeymap' 'akm' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
599 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
600 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
601 {only available when compiled with the |+farsi|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
602 feature}
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
603 When on, the second language is Farsi. In editing mode CTRL-_ toggles
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
604 the keyboard map between Farsi and English, when 'allowrevins' set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
605
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
606 When off, the keyboard map toggles between Hebrew and English. This
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
607 is useful to start the Vim in native mode i.e. English (left-to-right
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
608 mode) and have default second language Farsi or Hebrew (right-to-left
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
609 mode). See |farsi.txt|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
610
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
611 *'ambiwidth'* *'ambw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
612 'ambiwidth' 'ambw' string (default: "single")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
613 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
614 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
615 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
616 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
617 Only effective when 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
618 Tells Vim what to do with characters with East Asian Width Class
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
619 Ambiguous (such as Euro, Registered Sign, Copyright Sign, Greek
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
620 letters, Cyrillic letters).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
621
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
622 There are currently two possible values:
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
623 "single": Use the same width as characters in US-ASCII. This is
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
624 expected by most users.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
625 "double": Use twice the width of ASCII characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
626
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
627 There are a number of CJK fonts for which the width of glyphs for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
628 those characters are solely based on how many octets they take in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
629 legacy/traditional CJK encodings. In those encodings, Euro,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
630 Registered sign, Greek/Cyrillic letters are represented by two octets,
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
631 therefore those fonts have "wide" glyphs for them. This is also
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
632 true of some line drawing characters used to make tables in text
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
633 file. Therefore, when a CJK font is used for GUI Vim or
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
634 Vim is running inside a terminal (emulators) that uses a CJK font
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
635 (or Vim is run inside an xterm invoked with "-cjkwidth" option.),
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
636 this option should be set to "double" to match the width perceived
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
637 by Vim with the width of glyphs in the font. Perhaps it also has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
638 to be set to "double" under CJK Windows 9x/ME or Windows 2k/XP
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
639 when the system locale is set to one of CJK locales. See Unicode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
640 Standard Annex #11 (http://www.unicode.org/reports/tr11).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
641
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
642 *'antialias'* *'anti'* *'noantialias'* *'noanti'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
643 'antialias' 'anti' boolean (default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
644 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
645 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
646 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
647 on Mac OS X}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
648 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim on Mac OS X
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
649 v10.2 or later. When on, Vim will use smooth ("antialiased") fonts,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
650 which can be easier to read at certain sizes on certain displays.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
651 Setting this option can sometimes cause problems if 'guifont' is set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
652 to its default (empty string).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
653
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
654 *'autochdir'* *'acd'* *'noautochdir'* *'noacd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
655 'autochdir' 'acd' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
656 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
657 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
658 {only available when compiled with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
659 |+netbeans_intg| or |+sun_workshop| feature}
438
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
660 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
661 open a file, switch buffers, delete a buffer or open/close a window.
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
662 It will change to the directory containing the file which was opened
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
663 or selected.
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
664 This option is provided for backward compatibility with the Vim
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
665 released with Sun ONE Studio 4 Enterprise Edition.
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
666 Note: When this option is on some plugins may not work. The directory
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
667 browser sets if off.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
668
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
669 *'arabic'* *'arab'* *'noarabic'* *'noarab'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
670 'arabic' 'arab' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
671 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
672 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
673 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
674 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
675 This option can be set to start editing Arabic text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
676 Setting this option will:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
677 - Set the 'rightleft' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
678 - Set the 'arabicshape' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
679 - Set the 'keymap' option to "arabic"; in Insert mode CTRL-^ toggles
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
680 between typing English and Arabic key mapping.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
681 - Set the 'delcombine' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
682 Note that 'encoding' must be "utf-8" for working with Arabic text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
683
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
684 Resetting this option will:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
685 - Reset the 'rightleft' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
686 - Disable the use of 'keymap' (without changing its value).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
687 Note that 'arabicshape' and 'delcombine' are not reset (it is a global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
688 option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
689 Also see |arabic.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
690
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
691 *'arabicshape'* *'arshape'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
692 *'noarabicshape'* *'noarshape'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
693 'arabicshape' 'arshape' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
694 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
695 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
696 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
697 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
698 When on and 'termbidi' is off, the required visual character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
699 corrections that need to take place for displaying the Arabic language
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
700 take affect. Shaping, in essence, gets enabled; the term is a broad
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
701 one which encompasses:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
702 a) the changing/morphing of characters based on their location
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
703 within a word (initial, medial, final and stand-alone).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
704 b) the enabling of the ability to compose characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
705 c) the enabling of the required combining of some characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
706 When disabled the character display reverts back to each character's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
707 true stand-alone form.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
708 Arabic is a complex language which requires other settings, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
709 further details see |arabic.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
710
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
711 *'autoindent'* *'ai'* *'noautoindent'* *'noai'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
712 'autoindent' 'ai' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
713 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
714 Copy indent from current line when starting a new line (typing <CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
715 in Insert mode or when using the "o" or "O" command). If you do not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
716 type anything on the new line except <BS> or CTRL-D and then type
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
717 <Esc> or <CR>, the indent is deleted again. Moving the cursor to
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
718 another line has the same effect, unless the 'I' flag is included in
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
719 'cpoptions'.
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
720 When autoindent is on, formatting (with the "gq" command or when you
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
721 reach 'textwidth' in Insert mode) uses the indentation of the first
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
722 line.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
723 When 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is on the indent is changed in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
724 a different way.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
725 The 'autoindent' option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
726 {small difference from Vi: After the indent is deleted when typing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
727 <Esc> or <CR>, the cursor position when moving up or down is after the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
728 deleted indent; Vi puts the cursor somewhere in the deleted indent}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
729
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
730 *'autoread'* *'ar'* *'noautoread'* *'noar'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
731 'autoread' 'ar' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
732 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
733 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
734 When a file has been detected to have been changed outside of Vim and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
735 it has not been changed inside of Vim, automatically read it again.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
736 When the file has been deleted this is not done. |timestamp|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
737 If this option has a local value, use this command to switch back to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
738 using the global value: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
739 :set autoread<
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
740 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
741 *'autowrite'* *'aw'* *'noautowrite'* *'noaw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
742 'autowrite' 'aw' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
743 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
744 Write the contents of the file, if it has been modified, on each
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
745 :next, :rewind, :last, :first, :previous, :stop, :suspend, :tag, :!,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
746 :make, CTRL-] and CTRL-^ command; and when a CTRL-O, CTRL-I,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
747 '{A-Z0-9}, or `{A-Z0-9} command takes one to another file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
748 Note that for some commands the 'autowrite' option is not used, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
749 'autowriteall' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
750
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
751 *'autowriteall'* *'awa'* *'noautowriteall'* *'noawa'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
752 'autowriteall' 'awa' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
753 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
754 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
755 Like 'autowrite', but also used for commands ":edit", ":enew", ":quit",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
756 ":qall", ":exit", ":xit", ":recover" and closing the Vim window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
757 Setting this option also implies that Vim behaves like 'autowrite' has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
758 been set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
759
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
760 *'background'* *'bg'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
761 'background' 'bg' string (default "dark" or "light")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
762 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
763 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
764 When set to "dark", Vim will try to use colors that look good on a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
765 dark background. When set to "light", Vim will try to use colors that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
766 look good on a light background. Any other value is illegal.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
767 Vim tries to set the default value according to the terminal used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
768 This will not always be correct.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
769 Setting this option does not change the background color, it tells Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
770 what the background color looks like. For changing the background
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
771 color, see |:hi-normal|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
772
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
773 When 'background' is set Vim will adjust the default color groups for
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
774 the new value. But the colors used for syntax highlighting will not
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
775 change.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
776 When a color scheme is loaded (the "colors_name" variable is set)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
777 setting 'background' will cause the color scheme to be reloaded. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
778 the color scheme adjusts to the value of 'background' this will work.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
779 However, if the color scheme sets 'background' itself the effect may
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
780 be undone. First delete the "colors_name" variable when needed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
781
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
782 When setting 'background' to the default value with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
783 :set background&
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
784 < Vim will guess the value. In the GUI this should work correctly,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
785 in other cases Vim might not be able to guess the right value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
786
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
787 When starting the GUI, the default value for 'background' will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
788 "light". When the value is not set in the .gvimrc, and Vim detects
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
789 that the background is actually quite dark, 'background' is set to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
790 "dark". But this happens only AFTER the .gvimrc file has been read
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
791 (because the window needs to be opened to find the actual background
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
792 color). To get around this, force the GUI window to be opened by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
793 putting a ":gui" command in the .gvimrc file, before where the value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
794 of 'background' is used (e.g., before ":syntax on").
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
795 Normally this option would be set in the .vimrc file. Possibly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
796 depending on the terminal name. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
797 :if &term == "pcterm"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
798 : set background=dark
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
799 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
800 < When this option is set, the default settings for the highlight groups
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
801 will change. To use other settings, place ":highlight" commands AFTER
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
802 the setting of the 'background' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
803 This option is also used in the "$VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim" file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
804 to select the colors for syntax highlighting. After changing this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
805 option, you must load syntax.vim again to see the result. This can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
806 done with ":syntax on".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
807
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
808 *'backspace'* *'bs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
809 'backspace' 'bs' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
810 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
811 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
812 Influences the working of <BS>, <Del>, CTRL-W and CTRL-U in Insert
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
813 mode. This is a list of items, separated by commas. Each item allows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
814 a way to backspace over something:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
815 value effect ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
816 indent allow backspacing over autoindent
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
817 eol allow backspacing over line breaks (join lines)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
818 start allow backspacing over the start of insert; CTRL-W and CTRL-U
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
819 stop once at the start of insert.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
820
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
821 When the value is empty, Vi compatible backspacing is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
822
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
823 For backwards compatibility with version 5.4 and earlier:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
824 value effect ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
825 0 same as ":set backspace=" (Vi compatible)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
826 1 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
827 2 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,start"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
828
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
829 See |:fixdel| if your <BS> or <Del> key does not do what you want.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
830 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
831
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
832 *'backup'* *'bk'* *'nobackup'* *'nobk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
833 'backup' 'bk' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
834 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
835 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
836 Make a backup before overwriting a file. Leave it around after the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
837 file has been successfully written. If you do not want to keep the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
838 backup file, but you do want a backup while the file is being
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
839 written, reset this option and set the 'writebackup' option (this is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
840 the default). If you do not want a backup file at all reset both
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
841 options (use this if your file system is almost full). See the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
842 |backup-table| for more explanations.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
843 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
844 When 'patchmode' is set, the backup may be renamed to become the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
845 oldest version of a file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
846 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
847
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
848 *'backupcopy'* *'bkc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
849 'backupcopy' 'bkc' string (Vi default for Unix: "yes", otherwise: "auto")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
850 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
851 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
852 When writing a file and a backup is made, this option tells how it's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
853 done. This is a comma separated list of words.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
854
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
855 The main values are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
856 "yes" make a copy of the file and overwrite the original one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
857 "no" rename the file and write a new one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
858 "auto" one of the previous, what works best
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
859
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
860 Extra values that can be combined with the ones above are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
861 "breaksymlink" always break symlinks when writing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
862 "breakhardlink" always break hardlinks when writing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
863
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
864 Making a copy and overwriting the original file:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
865 - Takes extra time to copy the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
866 + When the file has special attributes, is a (hard/symbolic) link or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
867 has a resource fork, all this is preserved.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
868 - When the file is a link the backup will have the name of the link,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
869 not of the real file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
870
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
871 Renaming the file and writing a new one:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
872 + It's fast.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
873 - Sometimes not all attributes of the file can be copied to the new
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
874 file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
875 - When the file is a link the new file will not be a link.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
876
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
877 The "auto" value is the middle way: When Vim sees that renaming file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
878 is possible without side effects (the attributes can be passed on and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
879 and the file is not a link) that is used. When problems are expected,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
880 a copy will be made.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
881
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
882 The "breaksymlink" and "breakhardlink" values can be used in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
883 combination with any of "yes", "no" and "auto". When included, they
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
884 force Vim to always break either symbolic or hard links by doing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
885 exactly what the "no" option does, renaming the original file to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
886 become the backup and writing a new file in its place. This can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
887 useful for example in source trees where all the files are symbolic or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
888 hard links and any changes should stay in the local source tree, not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
889 be propagated back to the original source.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
890 *crontab*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
891 One situation where "no" and "auto" will cause problems: A program
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
892 that opens a file, invokes Vim to edit that file, and then tests if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
893 the open file was changed (through the file descriptor) will check the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
894 backup file instead of the newly created file. "crontab -e" is an
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
895 example.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
896
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
897 When a copy is made, the original file is truncated and then filled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
898 with the new text. This means that protection bits, owner and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
899 symbolic links of the original file are unmodified. The backup file
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
900 however, is a new file, owned by the user who edited the file. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
901 group of the backup is set to the group of the original file. If this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
902 fails, the protection bits for the group are made the same as for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
903 others.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
904
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
905 When the file is renamed this is the other way around: The backup has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
906 the same attributes of the original file, and the newly written file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
907 is owned by the current user. When the file was a (hard/symbolic)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
908 link, the new file will not! That's why the "auto" value doesn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
909 rename when the file is a link. The owner and group of the newly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
910 written file will be set to the same ones as the original file, but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
911 the system may refuse to do this. In that case the "auto" value will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
912 again not rename the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
913
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
914 *'backupdir'* *'bdir'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
915 'backupdir' 'bdir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
916 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,c:/tmp,c:/temp"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
917 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,~/")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
918 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
919 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
920 List of directories for the backup file, separated with commas.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
921 - The backup file will be created in the first directory in the list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
922 where this is possible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
923 - Empty means that no backup file will be created ('patchmode' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
924 impossible!). Writing may fail because of this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
925 - A directory "." means to put the backup file in the same directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
926 as the edited file.
33
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
927 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
928 put the backup file relative to where the edited file is. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
929 leading "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
930 ("." inside a directory name has no special meaning).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
931 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
932 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
933 name, precede it with a backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
934 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
935 - A directory name may end in an '/'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
936 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
937 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
938 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
939 :set bdir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
940 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
941 of the option is removed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
942 See also 'backup' and 'writebackup' options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
943 If you want to hide your backup files on Unix, consider this value: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
944 :set backupdir=./.backup,~/.backup,.,/tmp
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
945 < You must create a ".backup" directory in each directory and in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
946 home directory for this to work properly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
947 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
948 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
949 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
950 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
951 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
952
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
953 *'backupext'* *'bex'* *E589*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
954 'backupext' 'bex' string (default "~", for VMS: "_")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
955 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
956 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
957 String which is appended to a file name to make the name of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
958 backup file. The default is quite unusual, because this avoids
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
959 accidentally overwriting existing files with a backup file. You might
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
960 prefer using ".bak", but make sure that you don't have files with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
961 ".bak" that you want to keep.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
962 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
963
26
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
964 If you like to keep a lot of backups, you could use a BufWritePre
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
965 autocommand to change 'backupext' just before writing the file to
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
966 include a timestamp. >
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
967 :au BufWritePre * let &bex = '-' . strftime("%Y%b%d%X") . '~'
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
968 < Use 'backupdir' to put the backup in a different directory.
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
969
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
970 *'backupskip'* *'bsk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
971 'backupskip' 'bsk' string (default: "/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
972 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
973 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
974 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
975 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
976 A list of file patterns. When one of the patterns matches with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
977 name of the file which is written, no backup file is created. Both
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
978 the specified file name and the full path name of the file are used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
979 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
980 Watch out for special characters, see |option-backslash|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
981 When $TMPDIR, $TMP or $TEMP is not defined, it is not used for the
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
982 default value. "/tmp/*" is only used for Unix.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
983
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
984 *'balloondelay'* *'bdlay'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
985 'balloondelay' 'bdlay' number (default: 600)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
986 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
987 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
988 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
989 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
990 Delay in milliseconds before a balloon may pop up. See |balloon-eval|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
991
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
992 *'ballooneval'* *'beval'* *'noballooneval'* *'nobeval'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
993 'ballooneval' 'beval' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
994 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
995 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
996 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
997 feature}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
998 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
999
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1000 *'balloonexpr'* *'bexpr'*
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1001 'balloonexpr' 'bexpr' string (default "")
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1002 global
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1003 {not in Vi}
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1004 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1005 feature}
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1006 Expression to show in evaluation balloon. It is only used when
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1007 'ballooneval' is on. These variables can be used:
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1008
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1009 v:beval_bufnr number of the buffer in which balloon is going to show
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1010 v:beval_winnr number of the window
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1011 v:beval_lnum line number
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1012 v:beval_col column number (byte index)
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1013 v:beval_text word under or after the mouse pointer
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1014
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1015 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects!
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1016 Example: >
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1017 function! MyBalloonExpr()
435
73f016dbb279 updated for version 7.0112
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
1018 return 'Cursor is at line ' . v:beval_lnum .
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1019 \', column ' . v:beval_col .
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1020 \ ' of file ' . bufname(v:beval_bufnr) .
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1021 \ ' on word "' . v:beval_text . '"'
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1022 endfunction
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1023 set bexpr=MyBalloonExpr()
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1024 set ballooneval
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1025 <
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1026 NOTE: The balloon is displayed only if the cursor is on a text
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1027 character. If the result of evaluating 'balloonexpr' is not empty,
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1028 Vim does not try to send a message to an external debugger (Netbeans
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1029 or Sun Workshop).
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1030
446
7472c565592a updated for version 7.0117
vimboss
parents: 438
diff changeset
1031 To check whether line breaks in the balloon text work use this check: >
435
73f016dbb279 updated for version 7.0112
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
1032 if has("balloon_multiline")
73f016dbb279 updated for version 7.0112
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
1033 <
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1034 *'binary'* *'bin'* *'nobinary'* *'nobin'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1035 'binary' 'bin' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1036 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1037 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1038 This option should be set before editing a binary file. You can also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1039 use the |-b| Vim argument. When this option is switched on a few
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1040 options will be changed (also when it already was on):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1041 'textwidth' will be set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1042 'wrapmargin' will be set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1043 'modeline' will be off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1044 'expandtab' will be off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1045 Also, 'fileformat' and 'fileformats' options will not be used, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1046 file is read and written like 'fileformat' was "unix" (a single <NL>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1047 separates lines).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1048 The 'fileencoding' and 'fileencodings' options will not be used, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1049 file is read without conversion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1050 NOTE: When you start editing a(nother) file while the 'bin' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1051 on, settings from autocommands may change the settings again (e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1052 'textwidth'), causing trouble when editing. You might want to set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1053 'bin' again when the file has been loaded.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1054 The previous values of these options are remembered and restored when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1055 'bin' is switched from on to off. Each buffer has its own set of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1056 saved option values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1057 To edit a file with 'binary' set you can use the |++bin| argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1058 This avoids you have to do ":set bin", which would have effect for all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1059 files you edit.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1060 When writing a file the <EOL> for the last line is only written if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1061 there was one in the original file (normally Vim appends an <EOL> to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1062 the last line if there is none; this would make the file longer). See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1063 the 'endofline' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1064
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1065 *'bioskey'* *'biosk'* *'nobioskey'* *'nobiosk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1066 'bioskey' 'biosk' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1067 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1068 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS}
446
7472c565592a updated for version 7.0117
vimboss
parents: 438
diff changeset
1069 When on the BIOS is called to obtain a keyboard character. This works
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1070 better to detect CTRL-C, but only works for the console. When using a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1071 terminal over a serial port reset this option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1072 Also see |'conskey'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1073
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1074 *'bomb'* *'nobomb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1075 'bomb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1076 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1077 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1078 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1079 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1080 When writing a file and the following conditions are met, a BOM (Byte
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1081 Order Mark) is prepended to the file:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1082 - this option is on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1083 - the 'binary' option is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1084 - 'fileencoding' is "utf-8", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" or one of the little/big
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1085 endian variants.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1086 Some applications use the BOM to recognize the encoding of the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1087 Often used for UCS-2 files on MS-Windows. For other applications it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1088 causes trouble, for example: "cat file1 file2" makes the BOM of file2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1089 appear halfway the resulting file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1090 When Vim reads a file and 'fileencodings' starts with "ucs-bom", a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1091 check for the presence of the BOM is done and 'bomb' set accordingly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1092 Unless 'binary' is set, it is removed from the first line, so that you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1093 don't see it when editing. When you don't change the options, the BOM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1094 will be restored when writing the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1095
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1096 *'breakat'* *'brk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1097 'breakat' 'brk' string (default " ^I!@*-+;:,./?")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1098 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1099 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1100 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1101 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1102 This option lets you choose which characters might cause a line
500
4772a5e3f9fa updated for version 7.0138
vimboss
parents: 493
diff changeset
1103 break if 'linebreak' is on. Only works for ASCII and also for 8-bit
4772a5e3f9fa updated for version 7.0138
vimboss
parents: 493
diff changeset
1104 characters when 'encoding' is an 8-bit encoding.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1105
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1106 *'browsedir'* *'bsdir'*
29
ac33b7c03fac updated for version 7.0018
vimboss
parents: 26
diff changeset
1107 'browsedir' 'bsdir' string (default: "last")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1108 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1109 {not in Vi} {only for Motif and Win32 GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1110 Which directory to use for the file browser:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1111 last Use same directory as with last file browser.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1112 buffer Use the directory of the related buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1113 current Use the current directory.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1114 {path} Use the specified directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1115
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1116 *'bufhidden'* *'bh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1117 'bufhidden' 'bh' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1118 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1119 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1120 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1121 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1122 This option specifies what happens when a buffer is no longer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1123 displayed in a window:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1124 <empty> follow the global 'hidden' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1125 hide hide the buffer (don't unload it), also when 'hidden'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1126 is not set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1127 unload unload the buffer, also when 'hidden' is set or using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1128 |:hide|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1129 delete delete the buffer from the buffer list, also when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1130 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1131 |:bdelete|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1132 wipe wipe out the buffer from the buffer list, also when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1133 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1134 |:bwipeout|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1135
82
366d9947baf2 updated for version 7.0033
vimboss
parents: 75
diff changeset
1136 CAREFUL: when "unload", "delete" or "wipe" is used changes in a buffer
366d9947baf2 updated for version 7.0033
vimboss
parents: 75
diff changeset
1137 are lost without a warning.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1138 This option is used together with 'buftype' and 'swapfile' to specify
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1139 special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1140
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1141 *'buflisted'* *'bl'* *'nobuflisted'* *'nobl'* *E85*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1142 'buflisted' 'bl' boolean (default: on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1143 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1144 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1145 When this option is set, the buffer shows up in the buffer list. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1146 it is reset it is not used for ":bnext", "ls", the Buffers menu, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1147 This option is reset by Vim for buffers that are only used to remember
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1148 a file name or marks. Vim sets it when starting to edit a buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1149 But not when moving to a buffer with ":buffer".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1150
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1151 *'buftype'* *'bt'* *E382*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1152 'buftype' 'bt' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1153 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1154 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1155 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1156 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1157 The value of this option specifies the type of a buffer:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1158 <empty> normal buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1159 nofile buffer which is not related to a file and will not be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1160 written
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1161 nowrite buffer which will not be written
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1162 acwrite buffer which will always be written with BufWriteCmd
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1163 autocommands. {not available when compiled without the
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1164 |+autocmd| feature}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1165 quickfix quickfix buffer, contains list of errors |:cwindow|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1166 help help buffer (you are not supposed to set this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1167 manually)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1168
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1169 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'swapfile' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1170 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1171
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1172 Be careful with changing this option, it can have many side effects!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1173
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1174 A "quickfix" buffer is only used for the error list. This value is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1175 set by the |:cwindow| command and you are not supposed to change it.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1176
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1177 "nofile" and "nowrite" buffers are similar:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1178 both: The buffer is not to be written to disk, ":w" doesn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1179 work (":w filename" does work though).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1180 both: The buffer is never considered to be |'modified'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1181 There is no warning when the changes will be lost, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1182 example when you quit Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1183 both: A swap file is only created when using too much memory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1184 (when 'swapfile' has been reset there is never a swap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1185 file).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1186 nofile only: The buffer name is fixed, it is not handled like a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1187 file name. It is not modified in response to a |:cd|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1188 command.
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1189 *E676*
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1190 "acwrite" implies that the buffer name is not related to a file, like
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1191 "nofile", but it will be written. Thus, in contrast to "nofile" and
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1192 "nowrite", ":w" does work and a modified buffer can't be abandoned
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1193 without saving. For writing there must be matching |BufWriteCmd|,
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1194 |FileWriteCmd| or |FileAppendCmd| autocommands.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1195
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1196 *'casemap'* *'cmp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1197 'casemap' 'cmp' string (default: "internal,keepascii")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1198 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1199 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1200 Specifies details about changing the case of letters. It may contain
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1201 these words, separated by a comma:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1202 internal Use internal case mapping functions, the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1203 locale does not change the case mapping. This only
493
06364aa0d597 updated for version 7.0135
vimboss
parents: 488
diff changeset
1204 matters when 'encoding' is a Unicode encoding,
06364aa0d597 updated for version 7.0135
vimboss
parents: 488
diff changeset
1205 "latin1" or "iso-8859-15". When "internal" is
06364aa0d597 updated for version 7.0135
vimboss
parents: 488
diff changeset
1206 omitted, the towupper() and towlower() system library
06364aa0d597 updated for version 7.0135
vimboss
parents: 488
diff changeset
1207 functions are used when available.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1208 keepascii For the ASCII characters (0x00 to 0x7f) use the US
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1209 case mapping, the current locale is not effective.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1210 This probably only matters for Turkish.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1211
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1212 *'cdpath'* *'cd'* *E344* *E346*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1213 'cdpath' 'cd' string (default: equivalent to $CDPATH or ",,")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1214 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1215 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1216 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1217 |+file_in_path| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1218 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1219 |:cd| and |:lcd| commands, provided that the directory being searched
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1220 for has a relative path (not starting with "/", "./" or "../").
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1221 The 'cdpath' option's value has the same form and semantics as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1222 |'path'|. Also see |file-searching|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1223 The default value is taken from $CDPATH, with a "," prepended to look
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1224 in the current directory first.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1225 If the default value taken from $CDPATH is not what you want, include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1226 a modified version of the following command in your vimrc file to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1227 override it: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1228 :let &cdpath = ',' . substitute(substitute($CDPATH, '[, ]', '\\\0', 'g'), ':', ',', 'g')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1229 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1230 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1231 (parts of 'cdpath' can be passed to the shell to expand file names).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1232
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1233 *'cedit'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1234 'cedit' string (Vi default: "", Vim default: CTRL-F)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1235 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1236 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1237 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1238 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1239 The key used in Command-line Mode to open the command-line window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1240 The default is CTRL-F when 'compatible' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1241 Only non-printable keys are allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1242 The key can be specified as a single character, but it is difficult to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1243 type. The preferred way is to use the <> notation. Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1244 :set cedit=<C-Y>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1245 :set cedit=<Esc>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1246 < |Nvi| also has this option, but it only uses the first character.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1247 See |cmdwin|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1248
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1249 *'charconvert'* *'ccv'* *E202* *E214* *E513*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1250 'charconvert' 'ccv' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1251 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1252 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1253 feature and the |+eval| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1254 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1255 An expression that is used for character encoding conversion. It is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1256 evaluated when a file that is to be read or has been written has a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1257 different encoding from what is desired.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1258 'charconvert' is not used when the internal iconv() function is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1259 supported and is able to do the conversion. Using iconv() is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1260 preferred, because it is much faster.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1261 'charconvert' is not used when reading stdin |--|, because there is no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1262 file to convert from. You will have to save the text in a file first.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1263 The expression must return zero or an empty string for success,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1264 non-zero for failure.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1265 The possible encoding names encountered are in 'encoding'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1266 Additionally, names given in 'fileencodings' and 'fileencoding' are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1267 used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1268 Conversion between "latin1", "unicode", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" and "utf-8"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1269 is done internally by Vim, 'charconvert' is not used for this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1270 'charconvert' is also used to convert the viminfo file, if the 'c'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1271 flag is present in 'viminfo'. Also used for Unicode conversion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1272 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1273 set charconvert=CharConvert()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1274 fun CharConvert()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1275 system("recode "
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1276 \ . v:charconvert_from . ".." . v:charconvert_to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1277 \ . " <" . v:fname_in . " >" v:fname_out)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1278 return v:shell_error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1279 endfun
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1280 < The related Vim variables are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1281 v:charconvert_from name of the current encoding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1282 v:charconvert_to name of the desired encoding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1283 v:fname_in name of the input file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1284 v:fname_out name of the output file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1285 Note that v:fname_in and v:fname_out will never be the same.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1286 Note that v:charconvert_from and v:charconvert_to may be different
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1287 from 'encoding'. Vim internally uses UTF-8 instead of UCS-2 or UCS-4.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1288 Encryption is not done by Vim when using 'charconvert'. If you want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1289 to encrypt the file after conversion, 'charconvert' should take care
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1290 of this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1291 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1292 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1293
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1294 *'cindent'* *'cin'* *'nocindent'* *'nocin'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1295 'cindent' 'cin' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1296 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1297 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1298 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1299 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1300 Enables automatic C program indenting See 'cinkeys' to set the keys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1301 that trigger reindenting in insert mode and 'cinoptions' to set your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1302 preferred indent style.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1303 If 'indentexpr' is not empty, it overrules 'cindent'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1304 If 'lisp' is not on and both 'indentexpr' and 'equalprg' are empty,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1305 the "=" operator indents using this algorithm rather than calling an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1306 external program.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1307 See |C-indenting|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1308 When you don't like the way 'cindent' works, try the 'smartindent'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1309 option or 'indentexpr'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1310 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1311 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1312
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1313 *'cinkeys'* *'cink'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1314 'cinkeys' 'cink' string (default "0{,0},0),:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1315 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1316 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1317 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1318 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1319 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1320 the current line. Only used if 'cindent' is on and 'indentexpr' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1321 empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1322 For the format of this option see |cinkeys-format|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1323 See |C-indenting|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1324
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1325 *'cinoptions'* *'cino'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1326 'cinoptions' 'cino' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1327 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1328 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1329 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1330 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1331 The 'cinoptions' affect the way 'cindent' reindents lines in a C
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1332 program. See |cinoptions-values| for the values of this option, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1333 |C-indenting| for info on C indenting in general.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1334
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1335
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1336 *'cinwords'* *'cinw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1337 'cinwords' 'cinw' string (default "if,else,while,do,for,switch")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1338 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1339 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1340 {not available when compiled without both the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1341 |+cindent| and the |+smartindent| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1342 These keywords start an extra indent in the next line when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1343 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is set. For 'cindent' this is only done at
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1344 an appropriate place (inside {}).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1345 Note that 'ignorecase' isn't used for 'cinwords'. If case doesn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1346 matter, include the keyword both the uppercase and lowercase:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1347 "if,If,IF".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1348
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1349 *'clipboard'* *'cb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1350 'clipboard' 'cb' string (default "autoselect,exclude:cons\|linux"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1351 for X-windows, "" otherwise)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1352 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1353 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1354 {only in GUI versions or when the |+xterm_clipboard|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1355 feature is included}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1356 This option is a list of comma separated names.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1357 These names are recognized:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1358
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1359 unnamed When included, Vim will use the clipboard register '*'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1360 for all yank, delete, change and put operations which
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1361 would normally go to the unnamed register. When a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1362 register is explicitly specified, it will always be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1363 used regardless of whether "unnamed" is in 'clipboard'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1364 or not. The clipboard register can always be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1365 explicitly accessed using the "* notation. Also see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1366 |gui-clipboard|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1367
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1368 autoselect Works like the 'a' flag in 'guioptions': If present,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1369 then whenever Visual mode is started, or the Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1370 area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1371 windowing system's global selection or put the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1372 selected text on the clipboard used by the selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1373 register "*. See |guioptions_a| and |quotestar| for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1374 details. When the GUI is active, the 'a' flag in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1375 'guioptions' is used, when the GUI is not active, this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1376 "autoselect" flag is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1377 Also applies to the modeless selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1378
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1379 autoselectml Like "autoselect", but for the modeless selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1380 only. Compare to the 'A' flag in 'guioptions'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1381
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1382 exclude:{pattern}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1383 Defines a pattern that is matched against the name of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1384 the terminal 'term'. If there is a match, no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1385 connection will be made to the X server. This is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1386 useful in this situation:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1387 - Running Vim in a console.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1388 - $DISPLAY is set to start applications on another
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1389 display.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1390 - You do not want to connect to the X server in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1391 console, but do want this in a terminal emulator.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1392 To never connect to the X server use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1393 exclude:.*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1394 < This has the same effect as using the |-X| argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1395 Note that when there is no connection to the X server
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1396 the window title won't be restored and the clipboard
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1397 cannot be accessed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1398 The value of 'magic' is ignored, {pattern} is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1399 interpreted as if 'magic' was on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1400 The rest of the option value will be used for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1401 {pattern}, this must be the last entry.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1402
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1403 *'cmdheight'* *'ch'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1404 'cmdheight' 'ch' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1405 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1406 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1407 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line. Helps avoiding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1408 |hit-enter| prompts.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1409
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1410 *'cmdwinheight'* *'cwh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1411 'cmdwinheight' 'cwh' number (default 7)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1412 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1413 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1414 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1415 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1416 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line window. |cmdwin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1417
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1418 *'columns'* *'co'* *E594*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1419 'columns' 'co' number (default 80 or terminal width)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1420 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1421 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1422 Number of columns of the screen. Normally this is set by the terminal
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1423 initialization and does not have to be set by hand. Also see
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1424 |posix-screen-size|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1425 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1426 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1427 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1428 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1429 number of columns of the display, the display may be messed up.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1430
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1431 *'comments'* *'com'* *E524* *E525*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1432 'comments' 'com' string (default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1433 "s1:/*,mb:*,ex:*/,://,b:#,:%,:XCOMM,n:>,fb:-")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1434 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1435 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1436 {not available when compiled without the |+comments|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1437 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1438 A comma separated list of strings that can start a comment line. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1439 |format-comments|. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1440 insert a space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1441
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1442 *'commentstring'* *'cms'* *E537*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1443 'commentstring' 'cms' string (default "/*%s*/")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1444 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1445 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1446 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1447 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1448 A template for a comment. The "%s" in the value is replaced with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1449 comment text. Currently only used to add markers for folding, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1450 |fold-marker|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1451
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1452 *'compatible'* *'cp'* *'nocompatible'* *'nocp'*
378
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1453 'compatible' 'cp' boolean (default on, off when a .vimrc or .gvimrc file
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1454 is found)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1455 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1456 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1457 This option has the effect of making Vim either more Vi-compatible, or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1458 make Vim behave in a more useful way.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1459 This is a special kind of option, because when it's set or reset,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1460 other options are also changed as a side effect. CAREFUL: Setting or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1461 resetting this option can have a lot of unexpected effects: Mappings
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1462 are interpreted in another way, undo behaves differently, etc. If you
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1463 set this option in your vimrc file, you should probably put it at the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1464 very start.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1465 By default this option is on and the Vi defaults are used for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1466 options. This default was chosen for those people who want to use Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1467 just like Vi, and don't even (want to) know about the 'compatible'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1468 option.
378
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1469 When a ".vimrc" or ".gvimrc" file is found while Vim is starting up,
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1470 this option is switched off, and all options that have not been
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1471 modified will be set to the Vim defaults. Effectively, this means
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1472 that when a ".vimrc" or ".gvimrc" file exists, Vim will use the Vim
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1473 defaults, otherwise it will use the Vi defaults. (Note: This doesn't
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1474 happen for the system-wide vimrc or gvimrc file). Also see
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1475 |compatible-default| and |posix-compliance|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1476 You can also set this option with the "-C" argument, and reset it with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1477 "-N". See |-C| and |-N|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1478 Switching this option off makes the Vim defaults be used for options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1479 that have a different Vi and Vim default value. See the options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1480 marked with a '+' below. Other options are not modified.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1481 At the moment this option is set, several other options will be set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1482 or reset to make Vim as Vi-compatible as possible. See the table
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1483 below. This can be used if you want to revert to Vi compatible
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1484 editing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1485 See also 'cpoptions'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1486
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1487 option + set value effect ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1488
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1489 'allowrevins' off no CTRL-_ command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1490 'backupcopy' Unix: "yes" backup file is a copy
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1491 others: "auto" copy or rename backup file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1492 'backspace' "" normal backspace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1493 'backup' off no backup file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1494 'cindent' off no C code indentation
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1495 'cedit' + "" no key to open the |cmdwin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1496 'cpoptions' + (all flags) Vi-compatible flags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1497 'cscopetag' off don't use cscope for ":tag"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1498 'cscopetagorder' 0 see |cscopetagorder|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1499 'cscopeverbose' off see |cscopeverbose|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1500 'digraph' off no digraphs
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1501 'esckeys' + off no <Esc>-keys in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1502 'expandtab' off tabs not expanded to spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1503 'fileformats' + "" no automatic file format detection,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1504 "dos,unix" except for DOS, Windows and OS/2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1505 'formatoptions' + "vt" Vi compatible formatting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1506 'gdefault' off no default 'g' flag for ":s"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1507 'history' + 0 no commandline history
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1508 'hkmap' off no Hebrew keyboard mapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1509 'hkmapp' off no phonetic Hebrew keyboard mapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1510 'hlsearch' off no highlighting of search matches
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1511 'incsearch' off no incremental searching
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1512 'indentexpr' "" no indenting by expression
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1513 'insertmode' off do not start in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1514 'iskeyword' + "@,48-57,_" keywords contain alphanumeric
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1515 characters and '_'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1516 'joinspaces' on insert 2 spaces after period
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1517 'modeline' + off no modelines
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1518 'more' + off no pauses in listings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1519 'revins' off no reverse insert
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1520 'ruler' off no ruler
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1521 'scrolljump' 1 no jump scroll
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1522 'scrolloff' 0 no scroll offset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1523 'shiftround' off indent not rounded to shiftwidth
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1524 'shortmess' + "" no shortening of messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1525 'showcmd' + off command characters not shown
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1526 'showmode' + off current mode not shown
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1527 'smartcase' off no automatic ignore case switch
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1528 'smartindent' off no smart indentation
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1529 'smarttab' off no smart tab size
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1530 'softtabstop' 0 tabs are always 'tabstop' positions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1531 'startofline' on goto startofline with some commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1532 'tagrelative' + off tag file names are not relative
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1533 'textauto' + off no automatic textmode detection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1534 'textwidth' 0 no automatic line wrap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1535 'tildeop' off tilde is not an operator
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1536 'ttimeout' off no terminal timeout
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1537 'whichwrap' + "" left-right movements don't wrap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1538 'wildchar' + CTRL-E only when the current value is <Tab>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1539 use CTRL-E for cmdline completion
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1540 'writebackup' on or off depends on +writebackup feature
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1541
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1542 *'complete'* *'cpt'* *E535*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1543 'complete' 'cpt' string (default: ".,w,b,u,t,i")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1544 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1545 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1546 This option specifies how keyword completion |ins-completion| works
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1547 when CTRL-P or CTRL-N are used. It is also used for whole-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1548 completion |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-L|. It indicates the type of completion
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1549 and the places to scan. It is a comma separated list of flags:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1550 . scan the current buffer ('wrapscan' is ignored)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1551 w scan buffers from other windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1552 b scan other loaded buffers that are in the buffer list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1553 u scan the unloaded buffers that are in the buffer list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1554 U scan the buffers that are not in the buffer list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1555 k scan the files given with the 'dictionary' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1556 k{dict} scan the file {dict}. Several "k" flags can be given,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1557 patterns are valid too. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1558 :set cpt=k/usr/dict/*,k~/spanish
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1559 < s scan the files given with the 'thesaurus' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1560 s{tsr} scan the file {tsr}. Several "s" flags can be given, patterns
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1561 are valid too.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1562 i scan current and included files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1563 d scan current and included files for defined name or macro
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1564 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-D|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1565 ] tag completion
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1566 t same as "]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1567
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1568 Unloaded buffers are not loaded, thus their autocmds |:autocmd| are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1569 not executed, this may lead to unexpected completions from some files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1570 (gzipped files for example). Unloaded buffers are not scanned for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1571 whole-line completion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1572
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1573 The default is ".,w,b,u,t,i", which means to scan:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1574 1. the current buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1575 2. buffers in other windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1576 3. other loaded buffers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1577 4. unloaded buffers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1578 5. tags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1579 6. included files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1580
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1581 As you can see, CTRL-N and CTRL-P can be used to do any 'iskeyword'-
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
1582 based expansion (e.g., dictionary |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|, included patterns
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
1583 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-I|, tags |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-]| and normal expansions).
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1584
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1585 *'completefunc'* *'cfu'*
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1586 'completefunc' 'cfu' string (default: empty)
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1587 local to buffer
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1588 {not in Vi}
452
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1589 {not available when compiled without the +eval
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1590 or +insert_expand feature}
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1591 This option specifies a function to be used for CTRL-X CTRL-U
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1592 completion. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-U|
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1593
502
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1594 The function will be invoked with two arguments. First the function
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1595 is called to find the start of the text to be completed. Secondly the
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1596 function is called to actually find the matches.
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1597
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1598 On the first invocation the arguments are:
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1599 a:findstart 1
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1600 a:base empty
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1601
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1602 The function must return the column of where the completion starts.
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1603 It must be a number between zero and the cursor column "col('.')".
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1604 This involves looking at the characters just before the cursor and
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1605 including those characters that could be part of the completed item.
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1606 The text between this column and the cursor column will be replaced
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1607 with the matches. Return -1 if no completion can be done.
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1608
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1609 On the second invocation the arguments are:
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1610 a:findstart 0
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1611 a:base the text with which matches should match, what was
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1612 located in the first call
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1613
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1614 The function must return a List with the matching words. These
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1615 matches usually include the "a:base" text. When there are no matches
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1616 return an empty List.
452
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1617
464
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1618 When searching for matches takes some time call |complete_add()| to
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1619 add each match to the total list. These matches should then not
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1620 appear in the returned list! Call |complete_check()| now and then to
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1621 allow the user to press a key while still searching for matches. Stop
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1622 searching when it returns non-zero.
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1623
502
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1624 The function may move the cursor, it is restored afterwards.
464
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1625 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1626 security reasons.
452
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1627
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1628 An example that completes the names of the months: >
502
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1629 fun! CompleteMonths(findstart, base)
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1630 if a:findstart
452
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1631 " locate the start of the word
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1632 let line = getline('.')
502
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1633 let start = col('.') - 1
452
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1634 while start > 0 && line[start - 1] =~ '\a'
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1635 let start -= 1
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1636 endwhile
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1637 return start
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1638 else
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1639 " find months matching with "a:base"
452
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1640 let res = []
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1641 for m in split("Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec")
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1642 if m =~ '^' . a:base
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1643 call add(res, m)
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1644 endif
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1645 endfor
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1646 return res
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1647 endif
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1648 endfun
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1649 set completefunc=CompleteMonths
452
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1650 <
464
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1651 The same, but now pretending searching for matches is slow: >
502
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1652 fun! CompleteMonths(findstart, base)
464
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1653 if a:findstart
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1654 " locate the start of the word
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1655 let line = getline('.')
502
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
1656 let start = col('.') - 1
464
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1657 while start > 0 && line[start - 1] =~ '\a'
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1658 let start -= 1
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1659 endwhile
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1660 return start
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1661 else
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1662 " find months matching with "a:base"
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1663 for m in split("Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec")
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1664 if m =~ '^' . a:base
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1665 call complete_add(m)
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1666 endif
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1667 sleep 300m " simulate searching for next match
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1668 if complete_check()
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1669 break
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1670 endif
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1671 endfor
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1672 return []
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1673 endif
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1674 endfun
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1675 set completefunc=CompleteMonths
3b705e71c7b0 updated for version 7.0124
vimboss
parents: 459
diff changeset
1676 <
14
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
1677
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1678 *'confirm'* *'cf'* *'noconfirm'* *'nocf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1679 'confirm' 'cf' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1680 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1681 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1682 When 'confirm' is on, certain operations that would normally
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1683 fail because of unsaved changes to a buffer, e.g. ":q" and ":e",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1684 instead raise a |dialog| asking if you wish to save the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1685 file(s). You can still use a ! to unconditionally |abandon| a buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1686 If 'confirm' is off you can still activate confirmation for one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1687 command only (this is most useful in mappings) with the |:confirm|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1688 command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1689 Also see the |confirm()| function and the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1690
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1691 *'conskey'* *'consk'* *'noconskey'* *'noconsk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1692 'conskey' 'consk' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1693 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1694 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1695 When on direct console I/O is used to obtain a keyboard character.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1696 This should work in most cases. Also see |'bioskey'|. Together,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1697 three methods of console input are available:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1698 'conskey' 'bioskey' action ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1699 on on or off direct console input
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1700 off on BIOS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1701 off off STDIN
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1702
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1703 *'copyindent'* *'ci'* *'nocopyindent'* *'noci'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1704 'copyindent' 'ci' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1705 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1706 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1707 Copy the structure of the existing lines indent when autoindenting a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1708 new line. Normally the new indent is reconstructed by a series of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1709 tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is enabled,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1710 in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option makes the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1711 new line copy whatever characters were used for indenting on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1712 existing line. If the new indent is greater than on the existing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1713 line, the remaining space is filled in the normal manner.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1714 NOTE: 'copyindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1715 Also see 'preserveindent'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1716
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1717 *'cpoptions'* *'cpo'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1718 'cpoptions' 'cpo' string (Vim default: "aABceFs",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1719 Vi default: all flags)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1720 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1721 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1722 A sequence of single character flags. When a character is present
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1723 this indicates vi-compatible behavior. This is used for things where
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1724 not being vi-compatible is mostly or sometimes preferred.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1725 'cpoptions' stands for "compatible-options".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1726 Commas can be added for readability.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1727 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1728 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1729 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1730 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1731 NOTE: This option is set to the POSIX default value at startup when
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1732 the Vi default value would be used and the $VIM_POSIX environment
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1733 variable exists |posix|. This means tries to behave like the POSIX
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1734 specification.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1735
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1736 contains behavior ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1737 *cpo-a*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1738 a When included, a ":read" command with a file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1739 argument will set the alternate file name for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1740 current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1741 *cpo-A*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1742 A When included, a ":write" command with a file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1743 argument will set the alternate file name for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1744 current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1745 *cpo-b*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1746 b "\|" in a ":map" command is recognized as the end of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1747 the map command. The '\' is included in the mapping,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1748 the text after the '|' is interpreted as the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1749 command. Use a CTRL-V instead of a backslash to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1750 include the '|' in the mapping. Applies to all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1751 mapping, abbreviation, menu and autocmd commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1752 See also |map_bar|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1753 *cpo-B*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1754 B A backslash has no special meaning in mappings,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1755 abbreviations and the "to" part of the menu commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1756 Remove this flag to be able to use a backslash like a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1757 CTRL-V. For example, the command ":map X \<Esc>"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1758 results in X being mapped to:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1759 'B' included: "\^[" (^[ is a real <Esc>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1760 'B' excluded: "<Esc>" (5 characters)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1761 ('<' excluded in both cases)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1762 *cpo-c*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1763 c Searching continues at the end of any match at the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1764 cursor position, but not further than the start of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1765 next line. When not present searching continues
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1766 one character from the cursor position. With 'c'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1767 "abababababab" only gets three matches when repeating
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1768 "/abab", without 'c' there are five matches.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1769 *cpo-C*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1770 C Do not concatenate sourced lines that start with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1771 backslash. See |line-continuation|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1772 *cpo-d*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1773 d Using "./" in the 'tags' option doesn't mean to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1774 the tags file relative to the current file, but the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1775 tags file in the current directory.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1776 *cpo-D*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1777 D Can't use CTRL-K to enter a digraph after Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1778 commands with a character argument, like |r|, |f| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1779 |t|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1780 *cpo-e*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1781 e When executing a register with ":@r", always add a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1782 <CR> to the last line, also when the register is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1783 linewise. If this flag is not present, the register
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1784 is not linewise and the last line does not end in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1785 <CR>, then the last line is put on the command-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1786 and can be edited before hitting <CR>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1787 *cpo-E*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1788 E It is an error when using "y", "d", "c", "g~", "gu" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1789 "gU" on an Empty region. The operators only work when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1790 at least one character is to be operate on. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1791 This makes "y0" fail in the first column.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1792 *cpo-f*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1793 f When included, a ":read" command with a file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1794 argument will set the file name for the current buffer,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1795 if the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1796 *cpo-F*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1797 F When included, a ":write" command with a file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1798 argument will set the file name for the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1799 buffer, if the current buffer doesn't have a file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1800 yet.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1801 *cpo-g*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1802 g Goto line 1 when using ":edit" without argument.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1803 *cpo-H*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1804 H When using "I" on a line with only blanks, insert
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1805 before the last blank. Without this flag insert after
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1806 the last blank.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1807 *cpo-i*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1808 i When included, interrupting the reading of a file will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1809 leave it modified.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1810 *cpo-I*
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1811 I When moving the cursor up or down just after inserting
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1812 indent for 'autoindent', do not delete the indent.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1813 *cpo-j*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1814 j When joining lines, only add two spaces after a '.',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1815 not after '!' or '?'. Also see 'joinspaces'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1816 *cpo-J*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1817 J A |sentence| has to be followed by two spaces after
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
1818 the '.', '!' or '?'. A <Tab> is not recognized as
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1819 white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1820 *cpo-k*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1821 k Disable the recognition of raw key codes in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1822 mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of menu
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1823 commands. For example, if <Key> sends ^[OA (where ^[
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1824 is <Esc>), the command ":map X ^[OA" results in X
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1825 being mapped to:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1826 'k' included: "^[OA" (3 characters)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1827 'k' excluded: "<Key>" (one key code)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1828 Also see the '<' flag below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1829 *cpo-K*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1830 K Don't wait for a key code to complete when it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1831 halfway a mapping. This breaks mapping <F1><F1> when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1832 only part of the second <F1> has been read. It
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1833 enables cancelling the mapping by typing <F1><Esc>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1834 *cpo-l*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1835 l Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1836 literally, only "\]", "\^", "\-" and "\\" are special.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1837 See |/[]|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1838 'l' included: "/[ \t]" finds <Space>, '\' and 't'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1839 'l' excluded: "/[ \t]" finds <Space> and <Tab>
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1840 Also see |cpo-\|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1841 *cpo-L*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1842 L When the 'list' option is set, 'wrapmargin',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1843 'textwidth', 'softtabstop' and Virtual Replace mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1844 (see |gR|) count a <Tab> as two characters, instead of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1845 the normal behavior of a <Tab>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1846 *cpo-m*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1847 m When included, a showmatch will always wait half a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1848 second. When not included, a showmatch will wait half
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1849 a second or until a character is typed. |'showmatch'|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1850 *cpo-M*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1851 M When excluded, "%" matching will take backslashes into
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1852 account. Thus in "( \( )" and "\( ( \)" the outer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1853 parenthesis match. When included "%" ignores
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1854 backslashes, which is Vi compatible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1855 *cpo-n*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1856 n When included, the column used for 'number' will also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1857 be used for text of wrapped lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1858 *cpo-o*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1859 o Line offset to search command is not remembered for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1860 next search.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1861 *cpo-O*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1862 O Don't complain if a file is being overwritten, even
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1863 when it didn't exist when editing it. This is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1864 protection against a file unexpectedly created by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1865 someone else. Vi didn't complain about this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1866 *cpo-p*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1867 p Vi compatible Lisp indenting. When not present, a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1868 slightly better algorithm is used.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1869 *cpo-q*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1870 q When joining multiple lines leave the cursor at the
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1871 position where it would be when joining two lines.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1872 *cpo-r*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1873 r Redo ("." command) uses "/" to repeat a search
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1874 command, instead of the actually used search string.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1875 *cpo-R*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1876 R Remove marks from filtered lines. Without this flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1877 marks are kept like |:keepmarks| was used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1878 *cpo-s*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1879 s Set buffer options when entering the buffer for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1880 first time. This is like it is in Vim version 3.0.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1881 And it is the default. If not present the options are
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1882 set when the buffer is created.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1883 *cpo-S*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1884 S Set buffer options always when entering a buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1885 (except 'readonly', 'fileformat', 'filetype' and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1886 'syntax'). This is the (most) Vi compatible setting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1887 The options are set to the values in the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1888 buffer. When you change an option and go to another
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1889 buffer, the value is copied. Effectively makes the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1890 buffer options global to all buffers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1891
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1892 's' 'S' copy buffer options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1893 no no when buffer created
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1894 yes no when buffer first entered (default)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1895 X yes each time when buffer entered (vi comp.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1896 *cpo-t*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1897 t Search pattern for the tag command is remembered for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1898 "n" command. Otherwise Vim only puts the pattern in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1899 the history for search pattern, but doesn't change the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1900 last used search pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1901 *cpo-u*
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1902 u Undo is Vi compatible. See |undo-two-ways|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1903 *cpo-v*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1904 v Backspaced characters remain visible on the screen in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1905 Insert mode. Without this flag the characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1906 erased from the screen right away. With this flag the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1907 screen newly typed text overwrites backspaced
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1908 characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1909 *cpo-w*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1910 w When using "cw" on a blank character, only change one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1911 character and not all blanks until the start of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1912 next word.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1913 *cpo-W*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1914 W Don't overwrite a readonly file. When omitted, ":w!"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1915 overwrites a readonly file, if possible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1916 *cpo-x*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1917 x <Esc> on the command-line executes the command-line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1918 The default in Vim is to abandon the command-line,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1919 because <Esc> normally aborts a command. |c_<Esc>|
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1920 *cpo-X*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1921 X When using a count with "R" the replaced text is
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1922 deleted only once. Also when repeating "R" with "."
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1923 and a count.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1924 *cpo-y*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1925 y A yank command can be redone with ".".
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1926 *cpo-Z*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1927 Z When using "w!" while the 'readonly' option is set,
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1928 don't reset 'readonly'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1929 *cpo-!*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1930 ! When redoing a filter command, use the last used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1931 external command, whatever it was. Otherwise the last
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1932 used -filter- command is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1933 *cpo-$*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1934 $ When making a change to one line, don't redisplay the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1935 line, but put a '$' at the end of the changed text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1936 The changed text will be overwritten when you type the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1937 new text. The line is redisplayed if you type any
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1938 command that moves the cursor from the insertion
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1939 point.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1940 *cpo-%*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1941 % Vi-compatible matching is done for the "%" command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1942 Does not recognize "#if", "#endif", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1943 Does not recognize "/*" and "*/".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1944 Parens inside single and double quotes are also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1945 counted, causing a string that contains a paren to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1946 disturb the matching. For example, in a line like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1947 "if (strcmp("foo(", s))" the first paren does not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1948 match the last one. When this flag is not included,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1949 parens inside single and double quotes are treated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1950 specially. When matching a paren outside of quotes,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1951 everything inside quotes is ignored. When matching a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1952 paren inside quotes, it will find the matching one (if
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1953 there is one). This works very well for C programs.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
1954 This flag is also used for other features, such as
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
1955 C-indenting.
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1956 *cpo--*
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1957 - When included, a vertical movement command fails when
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1958 it would above the first line or below the last line.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1959 Without it the cursor moves to the first or last line,
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1960 unless it already was in that line.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1961 Applies to the commands "-", "k", CTRL-P, "+", "j",
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1962 CTRL-N and CTRL-J.
39
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
1963 *cpo-+*
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
1964 + When included, a ":write file" command will reset the
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
1965 'modified' flag of the buffer, even though the buffer
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
1966 itself may still be different from its file.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1967 *cpo-star*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1968 * Use ":*" in the same way as ":@". When not included,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1969 ":*" is an alias for ":'<,'>", select the Visual area.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1970 *cpo-<*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1971 < Disable the recognition of special key codes in |<>|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1972 form in mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1973 menu commands. For example, the command
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1974 ":map X <Tab>" results in X being mapped to:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1975 '<' included: "<Tab>" (5 characters)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1976 '<' excluded: "^I" (^I is a real <Tab>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1977 Also see the 'k' flag above.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1978 *cpo->*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1979 > When appending to a register, put a line break before
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1980 the appended text.
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1981
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1982 POSIX flags. These are not included in the Vi default value, except
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1983 when $VIM_POSIX was set on startup. |posix|
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1984
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1985 contains behavior ~
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1986 *cpo-#*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1987 # A count before "D", "o" and "O" has no effect.
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1988 *cpo-&*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1989 & When ":preserve" was used keep the swap file when
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1990 exiting normally while this buffer is still loaded.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1991 This flag is tested when exiting.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1992 *cpo-\*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1993 \ Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1994 literally, only "\]" is special See |/[]|
488
f00f0af2a320 updated for version 7.0133
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1995 '\' included: "/[ \-]" finds <Space>, '\' and '-'
f00f0af2a320 updated for version 7.0133
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1996 '\' excluded: "/[ \-]" finds <Space> and '-'
f00f0af2a320 updated for version 7.0133
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1997 Also see |cpo-l|.
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1998 *cpo-/*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1999 / When "%" is used as the replacement string in a |:s|
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2000 command, use the previous replacement string. |:s%|
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2001 *cpo-{*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2002 { The |{| and |}| commands also stop at a "{" character
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2003 at the start of a line.
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2004 *cpo-.*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2005 . The ":chdir" and ":cd" commands fail if the current
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2006 buffer is modified, unless ! is used. Vim doesn't
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2007 need this, since it remembers the full path of an
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2008 opened file.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2009 *cpo-bar*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2010 | The value of the $LINES and $COLUMNS environment
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2011 variables overrule the terminal size values obtained
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2012 with system specific functions.
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2013
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2014
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2015 *'cscopepathcomp'* *'cspc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2016 'cscopepathcomp' 'cspc' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2017 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2018 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2019 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2020 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2021 Determines how many components of the path to show in a list of tags.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2022 See |cscopepathcomp|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2023
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2024 *'cscopeprg'* *'csprg'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2025 'cscopeprg' 'csprg' string (default "cscope")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2026 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2027 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2028 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2029 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2030 Specifies the command to execute cscope. See |cscopeprg|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2031 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2032 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2033
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2034 *'cscopequickfix'* *'csqf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2035 'cscopequickfix' 'csqf' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2036 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2037 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2038 or |+quickfix| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2039 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2040 Specifies whether to use quickfix window to show cscope results.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2041 See |cscopequickfix|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2042
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2043 *'cscopetag'* *'cst'* *'nocscopetag'* *'nocst'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2044 'cscopetag' 'cst' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2045 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2046 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2047 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2048 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2049 Use cscope for tag commands. See |cscope-options|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2050 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2051
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2052 *'cscopetagorder'* *'csto'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2053 'cscopetagorder' 'csto' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2054 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2055 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2056 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2057 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2058 Determines the order in which ":cstag" performs a search. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2059 |cscopetagorder|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2060 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2061
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2062 *'cscopeverbose'* *'csverb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2063 *'nocscopeverbose'* *'nocsverb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2064 'cscopeverbose' 'csverb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2065 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2066 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2067 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2068 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2069 Give messages when adding a cscope database. See |cscopeverbose|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2070 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2071
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2072 *'debug'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2073 'debug' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2074 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2075 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2076 When set to "msg", error messages that would otherwise be omitted will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2077 be given anyway. This is useful when debugging 'foldexpr' or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2078 'indentexpr'.
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2079 When set to "beep", a message will be given when otherwise only a beep
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2080 would be produced.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2081 The values can be combined, separated by a comma.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2082
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2083 *'define'* *'def'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2084 'define' 'def' string (default "^\s*#\s*define")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2085 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2086 {not in Vi}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2087 Pattern to be used to find a macro definition. It is a search
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2088 pattern, just like for the "/" command. This option is used for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2089 commands like "[i" and "[d" |include-search|. The 'isident' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2090 used to recognize the defined name after the match:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2091 {match with 'define'}{non-ID chars}{defined name}{non-ID char}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2092 See |option-backslash| about inserting backslashes to include a space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2093 or backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2094 The default value is for C programs. For C++ this value would be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2095 useful, to include const type declarations: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2096 ^\(#\s*define\|[a-z]*\s*const\s*[a-z]*\)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2097 < When using the ":set" command, you need to double the backslashes!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2098
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2099 *'delcombine'* *'deco'* *'nodelcombine'* *'nodeco'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2100 'delcombine' 'deco' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2101 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2102 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2103 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2104 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2105 If editing Unicode and this option is set, backspace and Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2106 "x" delete each combining character on its own. When it is off (the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2107 default) the character along with its combining characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2108 deleted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2109 Note: When 'delcombine' is set "xx" may work different from "2x"!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2110
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2111 This is useful for Arabic, Hebrew and many other languages where one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2112 may have combining characters overtop of base characters, and want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2113 to remove only the combining ones.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2114
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2115 *'dictionary'* *'dict'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2116 'dictionary' 'dict' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2117 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2118 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2119 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2120 for keyword completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|. Each file should
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2121 contain a list of words. This can be one word per line, or several
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2122 words per line, separated by non-keyword characters (white space is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2123 preferred). Maximum line length is 510 bytes.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2124 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2125 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2126 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
99
04f2e519ab18 updated for version 7.0038
vimboss
parents: 82
diff changeset
2127 This has nothing to do with the |Dictionary| variable type.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2128 Where to find a list of words?
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2129 - On FreeBSD, there is the file "/usr/share/dict/words".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2130 - In the Simtel archive, look in the "msdos/linguist" directory.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2131 - In "miscfiles" of the GNU collection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2132 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2133 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2134 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2135 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2136
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2137 *'diff'* *'nodiff'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2138 'diff' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2139 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2140 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2141 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2142 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2143 Join the current window in the group of windows that shows differences
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2144 between files. See |vimdiff|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2145
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2146 *'dex'* *'diffexpr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2147 'diffexpr' 'dex' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2148 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2149 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2150 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2151 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2152 Expression which is evaluated to obtain an ed-style diff file from two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2153 versions of a file. See |diff-diffexpr|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2154 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2155 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2156
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2157 *'dip'* *'diffopt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2158 'diffopt' 'dip' string (default "filler")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2159 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2160 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2161 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2162 feature}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2163 Option settings for diff mode. It can consist of the following items.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2164 All are optional. Items must be separated by a comma.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2165
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2166 filler Show filler lines, to keep the text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2167 synchronized with a window that has inserted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2168 lines at the same position. Mostly useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2169 when windows are side-by-side and 'scrollbind'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2170 is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2171
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2172 context:{n} Use a context of {n} lines between a change
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2173 and a fold that contains unchanged lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2174 When omitted a context of six lines is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2175 See |fold-diff|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2176
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2177 icase Ignore changes in case of text. "a" and "A"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2178 are considered the same. Adds the "-i" flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2179 to the "diff" command if 'diffexpr' is empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2180
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2181 iwhite Ignore changes in amount of white space. Adds
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2182 the "-b" flag to the "diff" command if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2183 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2184 of the "diff" command for what this does
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2185 exactly. It should ignore adding trailing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2186 white space, but not leading white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2187
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2188 Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2189
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2190 :set diffopt=filler,context:4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2191 :set diffopt=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2192 :set diffopt=filler
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2193 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2194 *'digraph'* *'dg'* *'nodigraph'* *'nodg'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2195 'digraph' 'dg' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2196 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2197 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2198 {not available when compiled without the |+digraphs|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2199 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2200 Enable the entering of digraphs in Insert mode with {char1} <BS>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2201 {char2}. See |digraphs|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2202 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2203
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2204 *'directory'* *'dir'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2205 'directory' 'dir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2206 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,c:\tmp,c:\temp"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2207 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,/var/tmp,/tmp")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2208 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2209 List of directory names for the swap file, separated with commas.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2210 - The swap file will be created in the first directory where this is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2211 possible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2212 - Empty means that no swap file will be used (recovery is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2213 impossible!).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2214 - A directory "." means to put the swap file in the same directory as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2215 the edited file. On Unix, a dot is prepended to the file name, so
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2216 it doesn't show in a directory listing. On MS-Windows the "hidden"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2217 attribute is set and a dot prepended if possible.
33
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2218 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2219 put the swap file relative to where the edited file is. The leading
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2220 "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
459
d9d38102399f updated for version 7.0122
vimboss
parents: 452
diff changeset
2221 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//"
d9d38102399f updated for version 7.0122
vimboss
parents: 452
diff changeset
2222 or "\\", the swap file name will be built from the complete path to
d9d38102399f updated for version 7.0122
vimboss
parents: 452
diff changeset
2223 the file with all path separators substituted to percent '%' signs.
d9d38102399f updated for version 7.0122
vimboss
parents: 452
diff changeset
2224 This will ensure file name uniqueness in the preserve directory.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2225 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2226 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2227 name, precede it with a backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2228 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2229 - A directory name may end in an ':' or '/'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2230 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2231 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2232 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2233 :set dir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2234 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2235 of the option is removed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2236 Using "." first in the list is recommended. This means that editing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2237 the same file twice will result in a warning. Using "/tmp" on Unix is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2238 discouraged: When the system crashes you lose the swap file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2239 "/var/tmp" is often not cleared when rebooting, thus is a better
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2240 choice than "/tmp". But it can contain a lot of files, your swap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2241 files get lost in the crowd. That is why a "tmp" directory in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2242 home directory is tried first.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2243 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2244 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2245 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2246 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2247 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2248 {Vi: directory to put temp file in, defaults to "/tmp"}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2249
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2250 *'display'* *'dy'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2251 'display' 'dy' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2252 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2253 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2254 Change the way text is displayed. This is comma separated list of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2255 flags:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2256 lastline When included, as much as possible of the last line
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2257 in a window will be displayed. When not included, a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2258 last line that doesn't fit is replaced with "@" lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2259 uhex Show unprintable characters hexadecimal as <xx>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2260 instead of using ^C and ~C.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2261
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2262 *'eadirection'* *'ead'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2263 'eadirection' 'ead' string (default "both")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2264 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2265 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2266 {not available when compiled without the +vertsplit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2267 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2268 Tells when the 'equalalways' option applies:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2269 ver vertically, width of windows is not affected
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2270 hor horizontally, height of windows is not affected
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2271 both width and height of windows is affected
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2272
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2273 *'ed'* *'edcompatible'* *'noed'* *'noedcompatible'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2274 'edcompatible' 'ed' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2275 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2276 Makes the 'g' and 'c' flags of the ":substitute" command to be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2277 toggled each time the flag is given. See |complex-change|. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2278 also 'gdefault' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2279 Switching this option on is discouraged!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2280
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2281 *'encoding'* *'enc'* *E543*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2282 'encoding' 'enc' string (default: "latin1" or value from $LANG)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2283 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2284 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2285 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2286 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2287 Sets the character encoding used inside Vim. It applies to text in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2288 the buffers, registers, Strings in expressions, text stored in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2289 viminfo file, etc. It sets the kind of characters which Vim can work
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2290 with. See |encoding-names| for the possible values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2291
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2292 NOTE: Changing this option will not change the encoding of the
39
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2293 existing text in Vim. It may cause non-ASCII text to become invalid.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2294 It should normally be kept at its default value, or set when Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2295 starts up. See |multibyte|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2296
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2297 NOTE: For GTK+ 2 it is highly recommended to set 'encoding' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2298 "utf-8". Although care has been taken to allow different values of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2299 'encoding', "utf-8" is the natural choice for the environment and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2300 avoids unnecessary conversion overhead. "utf-8" has not been made
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2301 the default to prevent different behavior of the GUI and terminal
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2302 versions, and to avoid changing the encoding of newly created files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2303 without your knowledge (in case 'fileencodings' is empty).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2304
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2305 The character encoding of files can be different from 'encoding'.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2306 This is specified with 'fileencoding'. The conversion is done with
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2307 iconv() or as specified with 'charconvert'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2308
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2309 Normally 'encoding' will be equal to your current locale. This will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2310 be the default if Vim recognizes your environment settings. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2311 'encoding' is not set to the current locale, 'termencoding' must be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2312 set to convert typed and displayed text. See |encoding-table|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2313
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2314 When you set this option, it fires the |EncodingChanged| autocommand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2315 event so that you can set up fonts if necessary.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2316
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2317 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2318 you can set it with uppercase values too. Underscores are translated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2319 to '-' signs.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2320 When the encoding is recognized, it is changed to the standard name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2321 For example "Latin-1" becomes "latin1", "ISO_88592" becomes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2322 "iso-8859-2" and "utf8" becomes "utf-8".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2323
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2324 Note: "latin1" is also used when the encoding could not be detected.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2325 This only works when editing files in the same encoding! When the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2326 actual character set is not latin1, make sure 'fileencoding' and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2327 'fileencodings' are empty. When conversion is needed, switch to using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2328 utf-8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2329
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2330 When "unicode", "ucs-2" or "ucs-4" is used, Vim internally uses utf-8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2331 You don't notice this while editing, but it does matter for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2332 |viminfo-file|. And Vim expects the terminal to use utf-8 too. Thus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2333 setting 'encoding' to one of these values instead of utf-8 only has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2334 effect for encoding used for files when 'fileencoding' is empty.
448
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 446
diff changeset
2335
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 446
diff changeset
2336 When 'encoding' is set to a Unicode encoding, and 'fileencodings' was
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 446
diff changeset
2337 not set yet, the default for 'fileencodings' is changed.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2338
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2339 *'endofline'* *'eol'* *'noendofline'* *'noeol'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2340 'endofline' 'eol' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2341 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2342 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2343 When writing a file and this option is off and the 'binary' option
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2344 is on, no <EOL> will be written for the last line in the file. This
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2345 option is automatically set when starting to edit a new file, unless
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2346 the file does not have an <EOL> for the last line in the file, in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2347 which case it is reset. Normally you don't have to set or reset this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2348 option. When 'binary' is off the value is not used when writing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2349 file. When 'binary' is on it is used to remember the presence of a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2350 <EOL> for the last line in the file, so that when you write the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2351 the situation from the original file can be kept. But you can change
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2352 it if you want to.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2353
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2354 *'equalalways'* *'ea'* *'noequalalways'* *'noea'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2355 'equalalways' 'ea' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2356 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2357 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2358 When on, all the windows are automatically made the same size after
33
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2359 splitting or closing a window. This also happens the moment the
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2360 option is switched on. When off, splitting a window will reduce the
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2361 size of the current window and leave the other windows the same. When
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2362 closing a window the extra lines are given to the window next to it
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2363 (depending on 'splitbelow' and 'splitright').
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2364 When mixing vertically and horizontally split windows, a minimal size
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2365 is computed and some windows may be larger if there is room. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2366 'eadirection' option tells in which direction the size is affected.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2367 Changing the height of a window can be avoided by setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2368 'winfixheight'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2369
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2370 *'equalprg'* *'ep'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2371 'equalprg' 'ep' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2372 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2373 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2374 External program to use for "=" command. When this option is empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2375 the internal formatting functions are used ('lisp', 'cindent' or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2376 'indentexpr').
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2377 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2378 about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2379 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2380 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2381
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2382 *'errorbells'* *'eb'* *'noerrorbells'* *'noeb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2383 'errorbells' 'eb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2384 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2385 Ring the bell (beep or screen flash) for error messages. This only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2386 makes a difference for error messages, the bell will be used always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2387 for a lot of errors without a message (e.g., hitting <Esc> in Normal
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2388 mode). See 'visualbell' on how to make the bell behave like a beep,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2389 screen flash or do nothing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2390
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2391 *'errorfile'* *'ef'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2392 'errorfile' 'ef' string (Amiga default: "AztecC.Err",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2393 others: "errors.err")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2394 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2395 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2396 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2397 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2398 Name of the errorfile for the QuickFix mode (see |:cf|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2399 When the "-q" command-line argument is used, 'errorfile' is set to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2400 following argument. See |-q|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2401 NOT used for the ":make" command. See 'makeef' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2402 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2403 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2404 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2405 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2406
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2407 *'errorformat'* *'efm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2408 'errorformat' 'efm' string (default is very long)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2409 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2410 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2411 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2412 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2413 Scanf-like description of the format for the lines in the error file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2414 (see |errorformat|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2415
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2416 *'esckeys'* *'ek'* *'noesckeys'* *'noek'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2417 'esckeys' 'ek' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2418 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2419 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2420 Function keys that start with an <Esc> are recognized in Insert
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2421 mode. When this option is off, the cursor and function keys cannot be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2422 used in Insert mode if they start with an <Esc>. The advantage of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2423 this is that the single <Esc> is recognized immediately, instead of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2424 after one second. Instead of resetting this option, you might want to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2425 try changing the values for 'timeoutlen' and 'ttimeoutlen'. Note that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2426 when 'esckeys' is off, you can still map anything, but the cursor keys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2427 won't work by default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2428 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2429 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2430
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2431 *'eventignore'* *'ei'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2432 'eventignore' 'ei' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2433 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2434 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2435 {not available when compiled without the |+autocmd|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2436 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2437 A list of autocommand event names, which are to be ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2438 When set to "all", all autocommand events are ignored, autocommands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2439 will not be executed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2440 Otherwise this is a comma separated list of event names. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2441 :set ei=WinEnter,WinLeave
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2442 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2443 *'expandtab'* *'et'* *'noexpandtab'* *'noet'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2444 'expandtab' 'et' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2445 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2446 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2447 In Insert mode: Use the appropriate number of spaces to insert a
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2448 <Tab>. Spaces are used in indents with the '>' and '<' commands and
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2449 when 'autoindent' is on. To insert a real tab when 'expandtab' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2450 on, use CTRL-V<Tab>. See also |:retab| and |ins-expandtab|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2451 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2452
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2453 *'exrc'* *'ex'* *'noexrc'* *'noex'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2454 'exrc' 'ex' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2455 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2456 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2457 Enables the reading of .vimrc, .exrc and .gvimrc in the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2458 directory. If you switch this option on you should also consider
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2459 setting the 'secure' option (see |initialization|). Using a local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2460 .exrc, .vimrc or .gvimrc is a potential security leak, use with care!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2461 also see |.vimrc| and |gui-init|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2462 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2463 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2464
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2465 *'fileencoding'* *'fenc'* *E213*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2466 'fileencoding' 'fenc' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2467 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2468 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2469 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2470 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2471 Sets the character encoding for the file of this buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2472 When 'fileencoding' is different from 'encoding', conversion will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2473 done when reading and writing the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2474 When 'fileencoding' is empty, the same value as 'encoding' will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2475 used (no conversion when reading or writing a file).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2476 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2477 'encoding' is "utf-8" conversion is most likely done in a way
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2478 that the reverse conversion results in the same text. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2479 'encoding' is not "utf-8" some characters may be lost!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2480 See 'encoding' for the possible values. Additionally, values may be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2481 specified that can be handled by the converter, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2482 |mbyte-conversion|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2483 When reading a file 'fileencoding' will be set from 'fileencodings'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2484 To read a file in a certain encoding it won't work by setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2485 'fileencoding', use the |++enc| argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2486 Prepending "8bit-" and "2byte-" has no meaning here, they are ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2487 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2488 you can set it with uppercase values too. '_' characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2489 replaced with '-'. If a name is recognized from the list for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2490 'encoding', it is replaced by the standard name. For example
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2491 "ISO8859-2" becomes "iso-8859-2".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2492 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2493 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2494 If you do this in a modeline, you might want to set 'nomodified' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2495 avoid this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2496 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2497
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2498 *'fe'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2499 NOTE: Before version 6.0 this option specified the encoding for the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2500 whole of Vim, this was a mistake. Now use 'encoding' instead. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2501 old short name was 'fe', which is no longer used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2502
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2503 *'fileencodings'* *'fencs'*
39
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2504 'fileencodings' 'fencs' string (default: "ucs-bom",
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2505 "ucs-bom,utf-8,default,latin1" when
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2506 'encoding' is set to a Unicode value)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2507 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2508 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2509 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2510 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2511 This is a list of character encodings considered when starting to edit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2512 an existing file. When a file is read, Vim tries to use the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2513 mentioned character encoding. If an error is detected, the next one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2514 in the list is tried. When an encoding is found that works,
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2515 'fileencoding' is set to it. If all fail, 'fileencoding' is set to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2516 an empty string, which means the value of 'encoding' is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2517 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2518 'encoding' is "utf-8" (or one of the other Unicode variants)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2519 conversion is most likely done in a way that the reverse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2520 conversion results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2521 "utf-8" special characters may be lost!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2522 For an empty file or a file with only ASCII characters most encodings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2523 will work and the first entry of 'fileencodings' will be used (except
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2524 "ucs-bom", which requires the BOM to be present). If you prefer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2525 another encoding use an BufReadPost autocommand event to test if your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2526 preferred encoding is to be used. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2527 au BufReadPost * if search('\S', 'w') == 0 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2528 \ set fenc=iso-2022-jp | endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2529 < This sets 'fileencoding' to "iso-2022-jp" if the file does not contain
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2530 non-blank characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2531 Note that 'fileencodings' is not used for an new file, 'fileencoding'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2532 is always empty then. This means that a non-existing file may get a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2533 different encoding than an empty file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2534 The special value "ucs-bom" can be used to check for a Unicode BOM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2535 (Byte Order Mark) at the start of the file. It must not be preceded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2536 by "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding for this to work properly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2537 An entry for an 8-bit encoding (e.g., "latin1") should be the last,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2538 because Vim cannot detect an error, thus the encoding is always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2539 accepted.
39
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2540 The special value "default" can be used for the encoding from the
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2541 environment. This is the default value for 'encoding'. It is useful
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2542 when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and your environment uses a
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2543 non-latin1 encoding, such as Russian.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2544 WRONG VALUES: WHAT'S WRONG:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2545 latin1,utf-8 "latin1" will always be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2546 utf-8,ucs-bom,latin1 BOM won't be recognized in an utf-8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2547 file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2548 cp1250,latin1 "cp1250" will always be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2549 If 'fileencodings' is empty, 'fileencoding' is not modified.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2550 See 'fileencoding' for the possible values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2551 Setting this option does not have an effect until the next time a file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2552 is read.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2553
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2554 *'fileformat'* *'ff'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2555 'fileformat' 'ff' string (MS-DOS, MS-Windows, OS/2 default: "dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2556 Unix default: "unix",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2557 Macintosh default: "mac")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2558 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2559 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2560 This gives the <EOL> of the current buffer, which is used for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2561 reading/writing the buffer from/to a file:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2562 dos <CR> <NL>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2563 unix <NL>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2564 mac <CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2565 When "dos" is used, CTRL-Z at the end of a file is ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2566 See |file-formats| and |file-read|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2567 For the character encoding of the file see 'fileencoding'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2568 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformat' is ignored, file I/O
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2569 works like it was set to "unix'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2570 This option is set automatically when starting to edit a file and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2571 'fileformats' is not empty and 'binary' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2572 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2573 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2574 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2575 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to "dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2576 'textmode' is set, otherwise 'textmode' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2577
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2578 *'fileformats'* *'ffs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2579 'fileformats' 'ffs' string (default:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2580 Vim+Vi MS-DOS, MS-Windows OS/2: "dos,unix",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2581 Vim Unix: "unix,dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2582 Vim Mac: "mac,unix,dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2583 Vi Cygwin: "unix,dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2584 Vi others: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2585 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2586 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2587 This gives the end-of-line (<EOL>) formats that will be tried when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2588 starting to edit a new buffer and when reading a file into an existing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2589 buffer:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2590 - When empty, the format defined with 'fileformat' will be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2591 always. It is not set automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2592 - When set to one name, that format will be used whenever a new buffer
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2593 is opened. 'fileformat' is set accordingly for that buffer. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2594 'fileformats' name will be used when a file is read into an existing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2595 buffer, no matter what 'fileformat' for that buffer is set to.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2596 - When more than one name is present, separated by commas, automatic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2597 <EOL> detection will be done when reading a file. When starting to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2598 edit a file, a check is done for the <EOL>:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2599 1. If all lines end in <CR><NL>, and 'fileformats' includes "dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2600 'fileformat' is set to "dos".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2601 2. If a <NL> is found and 'fileformats' includes "unix", 'fileformat'
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2602 is set to "unix". Note that when a <NL> is found without a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2603 preceding <CR>, "unix" is preferred over "dos".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2604 3. If 'fileformats' includes "mac", 'fileformat' is set to "mac".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2605 This means that "mac" is only chosen when "unix" is not present,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2606 or when no <NL> is found in the file, and when "dos" is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2607 present, or no <CR><NL> is present in the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2608 Also if "unix" was first chosen, but the first <CR> is before
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2609 the first <NL> and there appears to be more <CR>'s than <NL>'s in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2610 the file, then 'fileformat' is set to "mac".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2611 4. If 'fileformat' is still not set, the first name from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2612 'fileformats' is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2613 When reading a file into an existing buffer, the same is done, but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2614 this happens like 'fileformat' has been set appropriately for that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2615 file only, the option is not changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2616 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformats' is not used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2617
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2618 For systems with a Dos-like <EOL> (<CR><NL>), when reading files that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2619 are ":source"ed and for vimrc files, automatic <EOL> detection may be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2620 done:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2621 - When 'fileformats' is empty, there is no automatic detection. Dos
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2622 format will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2623 - When 'fileformats' is set to one or more names, automatic detection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2624 is done. This is based on the first <NL> in the file: If there is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2625 <CR> in front of it, Dos format is used, otherwise Unix format is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2626 used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2627 Also see |file-formats|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2628 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to an empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2629 string or one format (no comma is included), 'textauto' is reset,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2630 otherwise 'textauto' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2631 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2632 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2633
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2634 *'filetype'* *'ft'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2635 'filetype' 'ft' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2636 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2637 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2638 {not available when compiled without the |+autocmd|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2639 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2640 When this option is set, the FileType autocommand event is triggered.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2641 All autocommands that match with the value of this option will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2642 executed. Thus the value of 'filetype' is used in place of the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2643 name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2644 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current file type.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2645 This option is normally set when the file type is detected. To enable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2646 this use the ":filetype on" command. |:filetype|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2647 Setting this option to a different value is most useful in a modeline,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2648 for a file for which the file type is not automatically recognized.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2649 Example, for in an IDL file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2650 /* vim: set filetype=idl : */
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2651 < |FileType| |filetypes|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2652 Do not confuse this option with 'osfiletype', which is for the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2653 type that is actually stored with the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2654 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2655 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2656 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2657
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2658 *'fillchars'* *'fcs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2659 'fillchars' 'fcs' string (default "vert:|,fold:-")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2660 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2661 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2662 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2663 and |+folding| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2664 Characters to fill the statuslines and vertical separators.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2665 It is a comma separated list of items:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2666
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2667 item default Used for ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2668 stl:c ' ' or '^' statusline of the current window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2669 stlnc:c ' ' or '-' statusline of the non-current windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2670 vert:c '|' vertical separators |:vsplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2671 fold:c '-' filling 'foldtext'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2672 diff:c '-' deleted lines of the 'diff' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2673
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2674 Any one that is omitted will fall back to the default. For "stl" and
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2675 "stlnc" the space will be used when there is highlighting, '^' or '-'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2676 otherwise.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2677
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2678 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2679 :set fillchars=stl:^,stlnc:-,vert:\|,fold:-,diff:-
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2680 < This is similar to the default, except that these characters will also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2681 be used when there is highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2682
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2683 The highlighting used for these items:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2684 item highlight group ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2685 stl:c StatusLine |hl-StatusLine|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2686 stlnc:c StatusLineNC |hl-StatusLineNC|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2687 vert:c VertSplit |hl-VertSplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2688 fold:c Folded |hl-Folded|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2689 diff:c DiffDelete |hl-DiffDelete|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2690
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2691 *'fkmap'* *'fk'* *'nofkmap'* *'nofk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2692 'fkmap' 'fk' boolean (default off) *E198*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2693 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2694 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2695 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2696 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2697 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Farsi character set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2698 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2699 toggle this option |i_CTRL-_|. See |farsi.txt|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2700
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2701 *'foldclose'* *'fcl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2702 'foldclose' 'fcl' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2703 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2704 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2705 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2706 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2707 When set to "all", a fold is closed when the cursor isn't in it and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2708 its level is higher than 'foldlevel'. Useful if you want folds to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2709 automatically close when moving out of them.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2710
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2711 *'foldcolumn'* *'fdc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2712 'foldcolumn' 'fdc' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2713 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2714 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2715 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2716 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2717 When non-zero, a column with the specified width is shown at the side
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2718 of the window which indicates open and closed folds. The maximum
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2719 value is 12.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2720 See |folding|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2721
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2722 *'foldenable'* *'fen'* *'nofoldenable'* *'nofen'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2723 'foldenable' 'fen' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2724 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2725 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2726 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2727 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2728 When off, all folds are open. This option can be used to quickly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2729 switch between showing all text unfolded and viewing the text with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2730 folds (including manually opened or closed folds). It can be toggled
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2731 with the |zi| command. The 'foldcolumn' will remain blank when
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2732 'foldenable' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2733 This option is set by commands that create a new fold or close a fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2734 See |folding|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2735
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2736 *'foldexpr'* *'fde'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2737 'foldexpr' 'fde' string (default: "0")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2738 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2739 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2740 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2741 or |+eval| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2742 The expression used for when 'foldmethod' is "expr". It is evaluated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2743 for each line to obtain its fold level. See |fold-expr|. Also see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2744 |eval-sandbox|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2745
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2746 *'foldignore'* *'fdi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2747 'foldignore' 'fdi' string (default: "#")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2748 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2749 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2750 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2751 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2752 Used only when 'foldmethod' is "indent". Lines starting with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2753 characters in 'foldignore' will get their fold level from surrounding
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2754 lines. White space is skipped before checking for this character.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2755 The default "#" works well for C programs. See |fold-indent|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2756
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2757 *'foldlevel'* *'fdl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2758 'foldlevel' 'fdl' number (default: 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2759 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2760 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2761 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2762 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2763 Sets the fold level: Folds with a higher level will be closed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2764 Setting this option to zero will close all folds. Higher numbers will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2765 close fewer folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2766 This option is set by commands like |zm|, |zM| and |zR|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2767 See |fold-foldlevel|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2768
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2769 *'foldlevelstart'* *'fdls'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2770 'foldlevelstart' 'fdls' number (default: -1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2771 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2772 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2773 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2774 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2775 Sets 'foldlevel' when starting to edit another buffer in a window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2776 Useful to always start editing with all folds closed (value zero),
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2777 some folds closed (one) or no folds closed (99).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2778 This is done before reading any modeline, thus a setting in a modeline
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2779 overrules this option. Starting to edit a file for |diff-mode| also
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2780 ignores this option and closes all folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2781 It is also done before BufReadPre autocommands, to allow an autocmd to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2782 overrule the 'foldlevel' value for specific files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2783 When the value is negative, it is not used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2784
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2785 *'foldmarker'* *'fmr'* *E536*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2786 'foldmarker' 'fmr' string (default: "{{{,}}}")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2787 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2788 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2789 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2790 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2791 The start and end marker used when 'foldmethod' is "marker". There
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2792 must be one comma, which separates the start and end marker. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2793 marker is a literal string (a regular expression would be too slow).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2794 See |fold-marker|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2795
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2796 *'foldmethod'* *'fdm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2797 'foldmethod' 'fdm' string (default: "manual")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2798 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2799 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2800 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2801 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2802 The kind of folding used for the current window. Possible values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2803 |fold-manual| manual Folds are created manually.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2804 |fold-indent| indent Lines with equal indent form a fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2805 |fold-expr| expr 'foldexpr' gives the fold level of a line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2806 |fold-marker| marker Markers are used to specify folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2807 |fold-syntax| syntax Syntax highlighting items specify folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2808 |fold-diff| diff Fold text that is not changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2809
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2810 *'foldminlines'* *'fml'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2811 'foldminlines' 'fml' number (default: 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2812 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2813 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2814 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2815 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2816 Sets the minimum number of screen lines for a fold to be displayed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2817 closed. Also for manually closed folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2818 Note that this only has an effect of what is displayed. After using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2819 "zc" to close a fold, which is displayed open because it's smaller
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2820 than 'foldminlines', a following "zc" may close a containing fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2821
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2822 *'foldnestmax'* *'fdn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2823 'foldnestmax' 'fdn' number (default: 20)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2824 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2825 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2826 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2827 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2828 Sets the maximum nesting of folds for the "indent" and "syntax"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2829 methods. This avoids that too many folds will be created. Using more
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2830 than 20 doesn't work, because the internal limit is 20.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2831
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2832 *'foldopen'* *'fdo'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2833 'foldopen' 'fdo' string (default: "block,hor,mark,percent,quickfix,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2834 search,tag,undo")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2835 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2836 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2837 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2838 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2839 Specifies for which type of commands folds will be opened, if the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2840 command moves the cursor into a closed fold. It is a comma separated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2841 list of items.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2842 item commands ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2843 all any
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2844 block "(", "{", "[[", "[{", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2845 hor horizontal movements: "l", "w", "fx", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2846 insert any command in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2847 jump far jumps: "G", "gg", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2848 mark jumping to a mark: "'m", CTRL-O, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2849 percent "%"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2850 quickfix ":cn", ":crew", ":make", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2851 search search for a pattern: "/", "n", "*", "gd", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2852 (not for a search pattern in a ":" command)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2853 tag jumping to a tag: ":ta", CTRL-T, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2854 undo undo or redo: "u" and CTRL-R
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2855 When the command is part of a mapping this option is not used. Add
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2856 the |zv| command to the mapping to get the same effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2857 When a movement command is used for an operator (e.g., "dl" or "y%")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2858 this option is not used. This means the operator will include the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2859 whole closed fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2860 Note that vertical movements are not here, because it would make it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2861 very difficult to move onto a closed fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2862 In insert mode the folds containing the cursor will always be open
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2863 when text is inserted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2864 To close folds you can re-apply 'foldlevel' with the |zx| command or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2865 set the 'foldclose' option to "all".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2866
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2867 *'foldtext'* *'fdt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2868 'foldtext' 'fdt' string (default: "foldtext()")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2869 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2870 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2871 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2872 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2873 An expression which is used to specify the text displayed for a closed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2874 fold. See |fold-foldtext|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2875
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2876 *'formatoptions'* *'fo'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2877 'formatoptions' 'fo' string (Vim default: "tcq", Vi default: "vt")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2878 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2879 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2880 This is a sequence of letters which describes how automatic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2881 formatting is to be done. See |fo-table|. When the 'paste' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2882 on, no formatting is done (like 'formatoptions' is empty). Commas can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2883 be inserted for readability.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2884 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2885 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2886 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2887 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2888
41
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2889 *'formatlistpat'* *'flp'*
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2890 'formatlistpat' 'flp' string (default: "^\s*\d\+[\]:.)}\t ]\s*")
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2891 local to buffer
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2892 {not in Vi}
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2893 A pattern that is used to recognize a list header. This is used for
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2894 the "n" flag in 'formatoptions'.
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2895 The pattern must match exactly the text that will be the indent for
140
8ecb0db93e9a updated for version 7.0045
vimboss
parents: 99
diff changeset
2896 the line below it. You can use |/\ze| to mark the end of the match
41
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2897 while still checking more characters. There must be a character
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2898 following the pattern, when it matches the whole line it is handled
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2899 like there is no match.
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2900 The default recognizes a number, followed by an optional punctuation
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2901 character and white space.
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2902
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2903 *'formatprg'* *'fp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2904 'formatprg' 'fp' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2905 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2906 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2907 The name of an external program that will be used to format the lines
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2908 selected with the "gq" command. The program must take the input on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2909 stdin and produce the output on stdout. The Unix program "fmt" is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2910 such a program. If this option is an empty string, the internal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2911 format function will be used |C-indenting|. Environment variables are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2912 expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2913 and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2914 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2915 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2916
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2917 *'fsync'* *'fs'*
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2918 'fsync' 'fs' boolean (default on)
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2919 global
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2920 {not in Vi}
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2921 When on, the library function fsync() will be called after writing a
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2922 file. This will flush a file to disk, ensuring that it is safely
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2923 written even on filesystems which do metadata-only journaling. This
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2924 will force the harddrive to spin up on Linux systems running in laptop
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2925 mode, so it may be undesirable in some situations. Be warned that
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2926 turning this off increases the chances of data loss after a crash. On
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2927 systems without an fsync() implementation, this variable is always
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2928 off.
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2929 Also see 'swapsync' for controlling fsync() on swap files.
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2930
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2931 *'gdefault'* *'gd'* *'nogdefault'* *'nogd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2932 'gdefault' 'gd' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2933 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2934 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2935 When on, the ":substitute" flag 'g' is default on. This means that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2936 all matches in a line are substituted instead of one. When a 'g' flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2937 is given to a ":substitute" command, this will toggle the substitution
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2938 of all or one match. See |complex-change|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2939
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2940 command 'gdefault' on 'gdefault' off ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2941 :s/// subst. all subst. one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2942 :s///g subst. one subst. all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2943 :s///gg subst. all subst. one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2944
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2945 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2946
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2947 *'grepformat'* *'gfm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2948 'grepformat' 'gfm' string (default "%f:%l%m,%f %l%m")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2949 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2950 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2951 Format to recognize for the ":grep" command output.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2952 This is a scanf-like string that uses the same format as the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2953 'errorformat' option: see |errorformat|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2954
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2955 *'grepprg'* *'gp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2956 'grepprg' 'gp' string (default "grep -n ",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2957 Unix: "grep -n $* /dev/null",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2958 Win32: "findstr /n" or "grep -n",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2959 VMS: "SEARCH/NUMBERS ")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2960 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2961 {not in Vi}
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
2962 Program to use for the |:grep| command. This option may contain '%'
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2963 and '#' characters, which are expanded like when used in a command-
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2964 line. The placeholder "$*" is allowed to specify where the arguments
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2965 will be included. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2966 |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2967 When your "grep" accepts the "-H" argument, use this to make ":grep"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2968 also work well with a single file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2969 :set grepprg=grep\ -nH
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
2970 < Special value: When 'grepprg' is set to "internal" the |:grep| command
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
2971 works like |:vimgrep| and |:grepadd| like |:vimgrepadd|.
41
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2972 See also the section |:make_makeprg|, since most of the comments there
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2973 apply equally to 'grepprg'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2974 For Win32, the default is "findstr /n" if "findstr.exe" can be found,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2975 otherwise it's "grep -n".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2976 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2977 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2978
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2979 *'guicursor'* *'gcr'* *E545* *E546* *E548* *E549*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2980 'guicursor' 'gcr' string (default "n-v-c:block-Cursor/lCursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2981 ve:ver35-Cursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2982 o:hor50-Cursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2983 i-ci:ver25-Cursor/lCursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2984 r-cr:hor20-Cursor/lCursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2985 sm:block-Cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2986 -blinkwait175-blinkoff150-blinkon175",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2987 for MS-DOS and Win32 console:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2988 "n-v-c:block,o:hor50,i-ci:hor15,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2989 r-cr:hor30,sm:block")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2990 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2991 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2992 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2993 for MS-DOS and Win32 console}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2994 This option tells Vim what the cursor should look like in different
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2995 modes. It fully works in the GUI. In an MSDOS or Win32 console, only
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2996 the height of the cursor can be changed. This can be done by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2997 specifying a block cursor, or a percentage for a vertical or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2998 horizontal cursor.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2999 For a console the 't_SI' and 't_EI' escape sequences are used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3000
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3001 The option is a comma separated list of parts. Each part consist of a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3002 mode-list and an argument-list:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3003 mode-list:argument-list,mode-list:argument-list,..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3004 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3005 n Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3006 v Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3007 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3008 if not specified)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3009 o Operator-pending mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3010 i Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3011 r Replace mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3012 c Command-line Normal (append) mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3013 ci Command-line Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3014 cr Command-line Replace mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3015 sm showmatch in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3016 a all modes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3017 The argument-list is a dash separated list of these arguments:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3018 hor{N} horizontal bar, {N} percent of the character height
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3019 ver{N} vertical bar, {N} percent of the character width
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3020 block block cursor, fills the whole character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3021 [only one of the above three should be present]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3022 blinkwait{N} *cursor-blinking*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3023 blinkon{N}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3024 blinkoff{N}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3025 blink times for cursor: blinkwait is the delay before
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3026 the cursor starts blinking, blinkon is the time that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3027 the cursor is shown and blinkoff is the time that the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3028 cursor is not shown. The times are in msec. When one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3029 of the numbers is zero, there is no blinking. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3030 default is: "blinkwait700-blinkon400-blinkoff250".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3031 These numbers are used for a missing entry. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3032 means that blinking is enabled by default. To switch
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3033 blinking off you can use "blinkon0". The cursor only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3034 blinks when Vim is waiting for input, not while
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3035 executing a command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3036 To make the cursor blink in an xterm, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3037 |xterm-blink|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3038 {group-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3039 a highlight group name, that sets the color and font
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3040 for the cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3041 {group-name}/{group-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3042 Two highlight group names, the first is used when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3043 no language mappings are used, the other when they
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3044 are. |language-mapping|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3045
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3046 Examples of parts:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3047 n-c-v:block-nCursor in Normal, Command-line and Visual mode, use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3048 block cursor with colors from the "nCursor"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3049 highlight group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3050 i-ci:ver30-iCursor-blinkwait300-blinkon200-blinkoff150
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3051 In Insert and Command-line Insert mode, use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3052 30% vertical bar cursor with colors from the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3053 "iCursor" highlight group. Blink a bit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3054 faster.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3055
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3056 The 'a' mode is different. It will set the given argument-list for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3057 all modes. It does not reset anything to defaults. This can be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3058 to do a common setting for all modes. For example, to switch off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3059 blinking: "a:blinkon0"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3060
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3061 Examples of cursor highlighting: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3062 :highlight Cursor gui=reverse guifg=NONE guibg=NONE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3063 :highlight Cursor gui=NONE guifg=bg guibg=fg
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3064 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3065 *'guifont'* *'gfn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3066 *E235* *E596* *E610* *E611*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3067 'guifont' 'gfn' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3068 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3069 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3070 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3071 This is a list of fonts which will be used for the GUI version of Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3072 In its simplest form the value is just one font name. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3073 the font cannot be found you will get an error message. To try other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3074 font names a list can be specified, font names separated with commas.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3075 The first valid font is used.
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3076
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3077 On systems where 'guifontset' is supported (X11) and 'guifontset' is
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3078 not empty, then 'guifont' is not used.
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3079
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3080 Spaces after a comma are ignored. To include a comma in a font name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3081 precede it with a backslash. Setting an option requires an extra
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3082 backslash before a space and a backslash. See also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3083 |option-backslash|. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3084 :set guifont=Screen15,\ 7x13,font\\,with\\,commas
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3085 < will make Vim try to use the font "Screen15" first, and if it fails it
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3086 will try to use "7x13" and then "font,with,commas" instead.
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3087
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3088 If none of the fonts can be loaded, Vim will keep the current setting.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3089 If an empty font list is given, Vim will try using other resource
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3090 settings (for X, it will use the Vim.font resource), and finally it
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3091 will try some builtin default which should always be there ("7x13" in
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3092 the case of X). The font names given should be "normal" fonts. Vim
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3093 will try to find the related bold and italic fonts.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3094
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3095 For Win32, GTK, Mac OS and Photon: >
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3096 :set guifont=*
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3097 < will bring up a font requester, where you can pick the font you want.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3098
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3099 The font name depends on the GUI used. See |setting-guifont| for a
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3100 way to set 'guifont' for various systems.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3101
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3102 For the GTK+ 2 GUI the font name looks like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3103 :set guifont=Andale\ Mono\ 11
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3104 < That's all. XLFDs are no longer accepted.
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3105
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3106 For Mac OSX you can use something like this: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3107 :set guifont=Monaco:h10
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3108 < *E236*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3109 Note that the fonts must be mono-spaced (all characters have the same
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3110 width). An exception is GTK 2: all fonts are accepted, but
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3111 mono-spaced fonts look best.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3112
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3113 To preview a font on X11, you might be able to use the "xfontsel"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3114 program. The "xlsfonts" program gives a list of all available fonts.
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3115
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3116 For the Win32 GUI *E244* *E245*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3117 - takes these options in the font name:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3118 hXX - height is XX (points, can be floating-point)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3119 wXX - width is XX (points, can be floating-point)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3120 b - bold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3121 i - italic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3122 u - underline
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3123 s - strikeout
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
3124 cXX - character set XX. Valid charsets are: ANSI, ARABIC,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3125 BALTIC, CHINESEBIG5, DEFAULT, EASTEUROPE, GB2312, GREEK,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3126 HANGEUL, HEBREW, JOHAB, MAC, OEM, RUSSIAN, SHIFTJIS,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3127 SYMBOL, THAI, TURKISH, VIETNAMESE ANSI and BALTIC.
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 20
diff changeset
3128 Normally you would use "cDEFAULT".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3129
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3130 Use a ':' to separate the options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3131 - A '_' can be used in the place of a space, so you don't need to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3132 backslashes to escape the spaces.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3133 - Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3134 :set guifont=courier_new:h12:w5:b:cRUSSIAN
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3135 :set guifont=Andale_Mono:h7.5:w4.5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3136 < See also |font-sizes|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3137
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3138 *'guifontset'* *'gfs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3139 *E250* *E252* *E234* *E597* *E598*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3140 'guifontset' 'gfs' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3141 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3142 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3143 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3144 with the |+xfontset| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3145 {not available in the GTK+ 2 GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3146 When not empty, specifies two (or more) fonts to be used. The first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3147 one for normal English, the second one for your special language. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3148 |xfontset|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3149 Setting this option also means that all font names will be handled as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3150 a fontset name. Also the ones used for the "font" argument of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3151 |:highlight| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3152 The fonts must match with the current locale. If fonts for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3153 character sets that the current locale uses are not included, setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3154 'guifontset' will fail.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3155 Note the difference between 'guifont' and 'guifontset': In 'guifont'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3156 the comma-separated names are alternative names, one of which will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3157 used. In 'guifontset' the whole string is one fontset name,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3158 including the commas. It is not possible to specify alternative
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3159 fontset names.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3160 This example works on many X11 systems: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3161 :set guifontset=-*-*-medium-r-normal--16-*-*-*-c-*-*-*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3162 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3163 *'guifontwide'* *'gfw'* *E231* *E533* *E534*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3164 'guifontwide' 'gfw' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3165 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3166 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3167 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3168 When not empty, specifies a comma-separated list of fonts to be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3169 for double-width characters. The first font that can be loaded is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3170 used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3171 Note: The size of these fonts must be exactly twice as wide as the one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3172 specified with 'guifont' and the same height.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3173
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3174 All GUI versions but GTK+ 2:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3175
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3176 'guifontwide' is only used when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3177 'guifontset' is empty or invalid.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3178 When 'guifont' is set and a valid font is found in it and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3179 'guifontwide' is empty Vim will attempt to find a matching
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3180 double-width font and set 'guifontwide' to it.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3181
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3182 GTK+ 2 GUI only: *guifontwide_gtk2*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3183
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3184 If set and valid, 'guifontwide' is always used for double width
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3185 characters, even if 'encoding' is not set to "utf-8".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3186 Vim does not attempt to find an appropriate value for 'guifontwide'
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3187 automatically. If 'guifontwide' is empty Pango/Xft will choose the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3188 font for characters not available in 'guifont'. Thus you do not need
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3189 to set 'guifontwide' at all unless you want to override the choice
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3190 made by Pango/Xft.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3191
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3192 *'guiheadroom'* *'ghr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3193 'guiheadroom' 'ghr' number (default 50)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3194 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3195 {not in Vi} {only for GTK and X11 GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3196 The number of pixels subtracted from the screen height when fitting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3197 the GUI window on the screen. Set this before the GUI is started,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3198 e.g., in your |gvimrc| file. When zero, the whole screen height will
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3199 be used by the window. When positive, the specified number of pixel
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3200 lines will be left for window decorations and other items on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3201 screen. Set it to a negative value to allow windows taller than the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3202 screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3203
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3204 *'guioptions'* *'go'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3205 'guioptions' 'go' string (default "gmrLtT" (MS-Windows),
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
3206 "agimrLtT" (GTK, Motif and Athena))
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3207 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3208 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3209 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3210 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim. It is a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3211 sequence of letters which describes what components and options of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3212 GUI should be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3213 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3214 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3215
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3216 Valid letters are as follows:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3217 *guioptions_a*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3218 'a' Autoselect: If present, then whenever VISUAL mode is started,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3219 or the Visual area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3220 the windowing system's global selection. This means that the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3221 Visually highlighted text is available for pasting into other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3222 applications as well as into Vim itself. When the Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3223 ends, possibly due to an operation on the text, or when an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3224 application wants to paste the selection, the highlighted text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3225 is automatically yanked into the "* selection register.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3226 Thus the selection is still available for pasting into other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3227 applications after the VISUAL mode has ended.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3228 If not present, then Vim won't become the owner of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3229 windowing system's global selection unless explicitly told to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3230 by a yank or delete operation for the "* register.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3231 The same applies to the modeless selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3232
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3233 'A' Autoselect for the modeless selection. Like 'a', but only
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3234 applies to the modeless selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3235
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3236 'guioptions' autoselect Visual autoselect modeless ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3237 "" - -
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3238 "a" yes yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3239 "A" - yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3240 "aA" yes yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3241
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3242 'c' Use console dialogs instead of popup dialogs for simple
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3243 choices.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3244
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3245 'f' Foreground: Don't use fork() to detach the GUI from the shell
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3246 where it was started. Use this for programs that wait for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3247 editor to finish (e.g., an e-mail program). Alternatively you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3248 can use "gvim -f" or ":gui -f" to start the GUI in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3249 foreground. |gui-fork|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3250 Note: Set this option in the vimrc file. The forking may have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3251 happened already when the gvimrc file is read.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3252
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3253 'i' Use a Vim icon. For GTK with KDE it is used in the left-upper
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3254 corner of the window. It's black&white on non-GTK, because of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3255 limitations of X11. For a color icon, see |X11-icon|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3256
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3257 'm' Menu bar is present.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3258 'M' The system menu "$VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim" is not sourced. Note
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3259 that this flag must be added in the .vimrc file, before
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3260 switching on syntax or filetype recognition (when the .gvimrc
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3261 file is sourced the system menu has already been loaded; the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3262 ":syntax on" and ":filetype on" commands load the menu too).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3263 'g' Grey menu items: Make menu items that are not active grey. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3264 'g' is not included inactive menu items are not shown at all.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3265 Exception: Athena will always use grey menu items.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3266
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3267 't' Include tearoff menu items. Currently only works for Win32,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3268 GTK+, and Motif 1.2 GUI.
236
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
3269 'T' Include Toolbar. Currently only in Win32, GTK+, Motif, Photon
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
3270 and Athena GUIs.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3271
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3272 'r' Right-hand scrollbar is always present.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3273 'R' Right-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3274 split window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3275 'l' Left-hand scrollbar is always present.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3276 'L' Left-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3277 split window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3278 'b' Bottom (horizontal) scrollbar is present. Its size depends on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3279 the longest visible line, or on the cursor line if the 'h'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3280 flag is included. |gui-horiz-scroll|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3281 'h' Limit horizontal scrollbar size to the length of the cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3282 line. Reduces computations. |gui-horiz-scroll|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3283
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3284 And yes, you may even have scrollbars on the left AND the right if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3285 you really want to :-). See |gui-scrollbars| for more information.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3286
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3287 'v' Use a vertical button layout for dialogs. When not included,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3288 a horizontal layout is preferred, but when it doesn't fit a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3289 vertical layout is used anyway.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3290 'p' Use Pointer callbacks for X11 GUI. This is required for some
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3291 window managers. If the cursor is not blinking or hollow at
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3292 the right moment, try adding this flag. This must be done
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3293 before starting the GUI. Set it in your gvimrc. Adding or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3294 removing it after the GUI has started has no effect.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3295 'F' Add a footer. Only for Motif. See |gui-footer|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3296
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3297 *'guipty'* *'noguipty'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3298 'guipty' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3299 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3300 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3301 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3302 Only in the GUI: If on, an attempt is made to open a pseudo-tty for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3303 I/O to/from shell commands. See |gui-pty|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3304
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3305 *'helpfile'* *'hf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3306 'helpfile' 'hf' string (default (MSDOS) "$VIMRUNTIME\doc\help.txt"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3307 (others) "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3308 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3309 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3310 Name of the main help file. All distributed help files should be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3311 placed together in one directory. Additionally, all "doc" directories
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3312 in 'runtimepath' will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3313 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. For example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3314 "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt". If $VIMRUNTIME is not set, $VIM is also
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3315 tried. Also see |$VIMRUNTIME| and |option-backslash| about including
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3316 spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3317 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3318 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3319
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3320 *'helpheight'* *'hh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3321 'helpheight' 'hh' number (default 20)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3322 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3323 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3324 {not available when compiled without the +windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3325 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3326 Minimal initial height of the help window when it is opened with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3327 ":help" command. The initial height of the help window is half of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3328 current window, or (when the 'ea' option is on) the same as other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3329 windows. When the height is less than 'helpheight', the height is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3330 set to 'helpheight'. Set to zero to disable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3331
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3332 *'helplang'* *'hlg'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3333 'helplang' 'hlg' string (default: messages language or empty)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3334 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3335 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_lang|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3336 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3337 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3338 Comma separated list of languages. Vim will use the first language
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3339 for which the desired help can be found. The English help will always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3340 be used as a last resort. You can add "en" to prefer English over
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3341 another language, but that will only find tags that exist in that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3342 language and not in the English help.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3343 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3344 :set helplang=de,it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3345 < This will first search German, then Italian and finally English help
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3346 files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3347 When using |CTRL-]| and ":help!" in a non-English help file Vim will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3348 try to find the tag in the current language before using this option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3349 See |help-translated|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3350
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3351 *'hidden'* *'hid'* *'nohidden'* *'nohid'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3352 'hidden' 'hid' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3353 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3354 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3355 When off a buffer is unloaded when it is |abandon|ed. When on a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3356 buffer becomes hidden when it is |abandon|ed. If the buffer is still
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3357 displayed in another window, it does not become hidden, of course.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3358 The commands that move through the buffer list sometimes make a buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3359 hidden although the 'hidden' option is off: When the buffer is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3360 modified, 'autowrite' is off or writing is not possible, and the '!'
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3361 flag was used. See also |windows.txt|.
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
3362 To only make one buffer hidden use the 'bufhidden' option.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3363 This option is set for one command with ":hide {command}" |:hide|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3364 WARNING: It's easy to forget that you have changes in hidden buffers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3365 Think twice when using ":q!" or ":qa!".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3366
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3367 *'highlight'* *'hl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3368 'highlight' 'hl' string (default (as a single string):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3369 "8:SpecialKey,@:NonText,d:Directory,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3370 e:ErrorMsg,i:IncSearch,l:Search,m:MoreMsg,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3371 M:ModeMsg,n:LineNr,r:Question,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3372 s:StatusLine,S:StatusLineNC,c:VertSplit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3373 t:Title,v:Visual,w:WarningMsg,W:WildMenu,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3374 f:Folded,F:FoldColumn,A:DiffAdd,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3375 C:DiffChange,D:DiffDelete,T:DiffText,
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3376 >:SignColumn,B:SpellBad,P:SpellCap,
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3377 R:SpellRare,L:SpellLocal")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3378 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3379 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3380 This option can be used to set highlighting mode for various
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3381 occasions. It is a comma separated list of character pairs. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3382 first character in a pair gives the occasion, the second the mode to
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3383 use for that occasion. The occasions are:
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3384 |hl-SpecialKey| 8 Meta and special keys listed with ":map"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3385 |hl-NonText| @ '~' and '@' at the end of the window and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3386 characters from 'showbreak'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3387 |hl-Directory| d directories in CTRL-D listing and other special
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3388 things in listings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3389 |hl-ErrorMsg| e error messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3390 h (obsolete, ignored)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3391 |hl-IncSearch| i 'incsearch' highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3392 |hl-Search| l last search pattern highlighting (see 'hlsearch')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3393 |hl-MoreMsg| m |more-prompt|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3394 |hl-ModeMsg| M Mode (e.g., "-- INSERT --")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3395 |hl-LineNr| n line number for ":number" and ":#" commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3396 |hl-Question| r |hit-enter| prompt and yes/no questions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3397 |hl-StatusLine| s status line of current window |status-line|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3398 |hl-StatusLineNC| S status lines of not-current windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3399 |hl-Title| t Titles for output from ":set all", ":autocmd" etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3400 |hl-VertSplit| c column used to separate vertically split windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3401 |hl-Visual| v Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3402 |hl-VisualNOS| V Visual mode when Vim does is "Not Owning the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3403 Selection" Only X11 Gui's |gui-x11| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3404 |xterm-clipboard|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3405 |hl-WarningMsg| w warning messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3406 |hl-WildMenu| W wildcard matches displayed for 'wildmenu'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3407 |hl-Folded| f line used for closed folds
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3408 |hl-FoldColumn| F 'foldcolumn'
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3409 |hl-DiffAdd| A added line in diff mode
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3410 |hl-DiffChange| C changed line in diff mode
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3411 |hl-DiffDelete| D deleted line in diff mode
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3412 |hl-DiffText| T inserted text in diff mode
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3413 |hl-SignColumn| > column used for |signs|
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
3414 |hl-SpellBad| B misspelled word |spell|
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3415 |hl-SpellCap| P word that should start with capital|spell|
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
3416 |hl-SpellRare| R rare word |spell|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
3417 |hl-SpellLocal| L word from other region |spell|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3418
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3419 The display modes are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3420 r reverse (termcap entry "mr" and "me")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3421 i italic (termcap entry "ZH" and "ZR")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3422 b bold (termcap entry "md" and "me")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3423 s standout (termcap entry "so" and "se")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3424 u underline (termcap entry "us" and "ue")
205
d292c40ca788 updated for version 7.0060
vimboss
parents: 199
diff changeset
3425 c undercurl (termcap entry "Cs" and "Ce")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3426 n no highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3427 - no highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3428 : use a highlight group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3429 The default is used for occasions that are not included.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3430 If you want to change what the display modes do, see |dos-colors|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3431 for an example.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3432 When using the ':' display mode, this must be followed by the name of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3433 a highlight group. A highlight group can be used to define any type
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3434 of highlighting, including using color. See |:highlight| on how to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3435 define one. The default uses a different group for each occasion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3436 See |highlight-default| for the default highlight groups.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3437
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3438 *'hlsearch'* *'hls'* *'nohlsearch'* *'nohls'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3439 'hlsearch' 'hls' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3440 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3441 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3442 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3443 |+extra_search| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3444 When there is a previous search pattern, highlight all its matches.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3445 The type of highlighting used can be set with the 'l' occasion in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3446 'highlight' option. This uses the "Search" highlight group by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3447 default. Note that only the matching text is highlighted, any offsets
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3448 are not applied.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3449 See also: 'incsearch' and |:match|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3450 When you get bored looking at the highlighted matches, you can turn it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3451 off with |:nohlsearch|. As soon as you use a search command, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3452 highlighting comes back.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3453 When the search pattern can match an end-of-line, Vim will try to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3454 highlight all of the matched text. However, this depends on where the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3455 search starts. This will be the first line in the window or the first
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3456 line below a closed fold. A match in a previous line which is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3457 drawn may not continue in an newly drawn line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3458 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3459
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3460 *'history'* *'hi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3461 'history' 'hi' number (Vim default: 20, Vi default: 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3462 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3463 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3464 A history of ":" commands, and a history of previous search patterns
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3465 are remembered. This option decides how many entries may be stored in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3466 each of these histories (see |cmdline-editing|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3467 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3468 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3469
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3470 *'hkmap'* *'hk'* *'nohkmap'* *'nohk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3471 'hkmap' 'hk' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3472 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3473 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3474 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3475 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3476 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Hebrew character set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3477 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3478 toggle this option. See |rileft.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3479 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3480
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3481 *'hkmapp'* *'hkp'* *'nohkmapp'* *'nohkp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3482 'hkmapp' 'hkp' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3483 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3484 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3485 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3486 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3487 When on, phonetic keyboard mapping is used. 'hkmap' must also be on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3488 This is useful if you have a non-Hebrew keyboard.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3489 See |rileft.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3490 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3491
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3492 *'icon'* *'noicon'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3493 'icon' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3494 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3495 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3496 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3497 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3498 When on, the icon text of the window will be set to the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3499 'iconstring' (if it is not empty), or to the name of the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3500 currently being edited. Only the last part of the name is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3501 Overridden by the 'iconstring' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3502 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icons (currently
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3503 only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option - these are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3504 Unix xterm and iris-ansi by default, where 't_IS' is taken from the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3505 builtin termcap).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3506 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
3507 restored if possible |X11|. See |X11-icon| for changing the icon on
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3508 X11.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3509
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3510 *'iconstring'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3511 'iconstring' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3512 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3513 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3514 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3515 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3516 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the icon text of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3517 the window. This happens only when the 'icon' option is on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3518 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icon text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3519 (currently only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3520 Does not work for MS Windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3521 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3522 restored if possible |X11|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3523 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3524 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. See
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3525 'titlestring' for example settings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3526 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3527
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3528 *'ignorecase'* *'ic'* *'noignorecase'* *'noic'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3529 'ignorecase' 'ic' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3530 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3531 Ignore case in search patterns. Also used when searching in the tags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3532 file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3533 Also see 'smartcase'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3534 Can be overruled by using "\c" or "\C" in the pattern, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3535 |/ignorecase|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3536
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3537 *'imactivatekey'* *'imak'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3538 'imactivatekey' 'imak' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3539 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3540 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3541 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3542 |+GUI_GTK|}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3543 Specifies the key that your Input Method in X-Windows uses for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3544 activation. When this is specified correctly, vim can fully control
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3545 IM with 'imcmdline', 'iminsert' and 'imsearch'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3546 You can't use this option to change the activation key, the option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3547 tells Vim what the key is.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3548 Format:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3549 [MODIFIER_FLAG-]KEY_STRING
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3550
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3551 These characters can be used for MODIFIER_FLAG (case is ignored):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3552 S Shift key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3553 L Lock key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3554 C Control key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3555 1 Mod1 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3556 2 Mod2 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3557 3 Mod3 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3558 4 Mod4 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3559 5 Mod5 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3560 Combinations are allowed, for example "S-C-space" or "SC-space" are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3561 both shift+ctrl+space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3562 See <X11/keysymdef.h> and XStringToKeysym for KEY_STRING.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3563
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3564 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3565 :set imactivatekey=S-space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3566 < "S-space" means shift+space. This is the activation key for kinput2 +
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3567 canna (Japanese), and ami (Korean).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3568
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3569 *'imcmdline'* *'imc'* *'noimcmdline'* *'noimc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3570 'imcmdline' 'imc' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3571 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3572 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3573 {only available when compiled with the |+xim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3574 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3575 When set the Input Method is always on when starting to edit a command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3576 line, unless entering a search pattern (see 'imsearch' for that).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3577 Setting this option is useful when your input method allows entering
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3578 English characters directly, e.g., when it's used to type accented
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3579 characters with dead keys.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3580
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3581 *'imdisable'* *'imd'* *'nodisable'* *'noimd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3582 'imdisable' 'imd' boolean (default off, on for some systems (SGI))
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3583 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3584 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3585 {only available when compiled with the |+xim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3586 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3587 When set the Input Method is never used. This is useful to disable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3588 the IM when it doesn't work properly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3589 Currently this option is on by default for SGI/IRIX machines. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3590 may change in later releases.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3591
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3592 *'iminsert'* *'imi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3593 'iminsert' 'imi' number (default 0, 2 when an input method is supported)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3594 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3595 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3596 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3597 Insert mode. Valid values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3598 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3599 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3600 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3601 2 is available only when compiled with the |+multi_byte_ime|, |+xim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3602 or |global-ime|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3603 To always reset the option to zero when leaving Insert mode with <Esc>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3604 this can be used: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3605 :inoremap <ESC> <ESC>:set iminsert=0<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3606 < This makes :lmap and IM turn off automatically when leaving Insert
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3607 mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3608 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3609 |i_CTRL-^|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3610 The value is set to 1 when setting 'keymap' to a valid keymap name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3611 It is also used for the argument of commands like "r" and "f".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3612 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3613 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3614
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3615 *'imsearch'* *'ims'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3616 'imsearch' 'ims' number (default 0, 2 when an input method is supported)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3617 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3618 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3619 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3620 entering a search pattern. Valid values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3621 -1 the value of 'iminsert' is used, makes it look like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3622 'iminsert' is also used when typing a search pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3623 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3624 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3625 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3626 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Command-line mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3627 |c_CTRL-^|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3628 The value is set to 1 when it is not -1 and setting the 'keymap'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3629 option to a valid keymap name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3630 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3631 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3632
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3633 *'include'* *'inc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3634 'include' 'inc' string (default "^\s*#\s*include")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3635 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3636 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3637 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3638 |+find_in_path| feature}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3639 Pattern to be used to find an include command. It is a search
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3640 pattern, just like for the "/" command (See |pattern|). The default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3641 value is for C programs. This option is used for the commands "[i",
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
3642 "]I", "[d", etc. The 'isfname' option is used to recognize the file
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3643 name that comes after the matched pattern. See |option-backslash|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3644 about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3645
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3646 *'includeexpr'* *'inex'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3647 'includeexpr' 'inex' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3648 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3649 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3650 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3651 |+find_in_path| or |+eval| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3652 Expression to be used to transform the string found with the 'include'
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3653 option to a file name. Mostly useful to change "." to "/" for Java: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3654 :set includeexpr=substitute(v:fname,'\\.','/','g')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3655 < The "v:fname" variable will be set to the file name that was detected.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3656 Evaluated in the |sandbox|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3657 Also used for the |gf| command if an unmodified file name can't be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3658 found. Allows doing "gf" on the name after an 'include' statement.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3659 Also used for |<cfile>|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3660
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3661 *'incsearch'* *'is'* *'noincsearch'* *'nois'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3662 'incsearch' 'is' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3663 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3664 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3665 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3666 |+extra_search| feature}
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3667 While typing a search command, show where the pattern, as it was typed
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3668 so far, matches. The matched string is highlighted. If the pattern
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3669 is invalid or not found, nothing is shown. The screen will be updated
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3670 often, this is only useful on fast terminals.
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3671 Note that the match will be shown, but the cursor will return to its
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3672 original position when no match is found and when pressing <Esc>. You
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3673 still need to finish the search command with <Enter> to move the
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3674 cursor to the match.
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3675 The highlighting can be set with the 'i' flag in 'highlight'.
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3676 See also: 'hlsearch'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3677 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3678
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3679 *'indentexpr'* *'inde'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3680 'indentexpr' 'inde' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3681 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3682 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3683 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3684 or |+eval| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3685 Expression which is evaluated to obtain the proper indent for a line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3686 It is used when a new line is created, for the |=| operator and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3687 in Insert mode as specified with the 'indentkeys' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3688 When this option is not empty, it overrules the 'cindent' and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3689 'smartindent' indenting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3690 When 'paste' is set this option is not used for indenting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3691 The expression is evaluated with |v:lnum| set to the line number for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3692 which the indent is to be computed. The cursor is also as this line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3693 when the expression is evaluated (but it may be moved around).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3694 The expression must return the number of spaces worth of indent. It
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3695 can return "-1" to keep the current indent (this means 'autoindent' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3696 used for the indent).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3697 Functions useful for computing the indent are |indent()|, |cindent()|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3698 and |lispindent()|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3699 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! It must
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3700 not change the text, jump to another window, etc. Afterwards the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3701 cursor position is always restored, thus the cursor may be moved.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3702 Normally this option would be set to call a function: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3703 :set indentexpr=GetMyIndent()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3704 < Error messages will be suppressed, unless the 'debug' option contains
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3705 "msg".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3706 See |indent-expression|. Also see |eval-sandbox|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3707 NOTE: This option is made empty when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3708
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3709 *'indentkeys'* *'indk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3710 'indentkeys' 'indk' string (default "0{,0},:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3711 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3712 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3713 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3714 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3715 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3716 the current line. Only happens if 'indentexpr' isn't empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3717 The format is identical to 'cinkeys', see |indentkeys-format|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3718 See |C-indenting| and |indent-expression|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3719
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3720 *'infercase'* *'inf'* *'noinfercase'* *'noinf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3721 'infercase' 'inf' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3722 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3723 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3724 When doing keyword completion in insert mode |ins-completion|, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3725 'ignorecase' is also on, the case of the match is adjusted. If the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3726 typed text contains a lowercase letter where the match has an upper
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3727 case letter, the completed part is made lowercase. If the typed text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3728 has no lowercase letters and the match has a lowercase letter where
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3729 the typed text has an uppercase letter, and there is a letter before
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3730 it, the completed part is made uppercase.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3731
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3732 *'insertmode'* *'im'* *'noinsertmode'* *'noim'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3733 'insertmode' 'im' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3734 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3735 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3736 Makes Vim work in a way that Insert mode is the default mode. Useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3737 if you want to use Vim as a modeless editor. Used for |evim|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3738 These Insert mode commands will be useful:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3739 - Use the cursor keys to move around.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3740 - Use CTRL-O to execute one Normal mode command |i_CTRL-O|). When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3741 this is a mapping, it is executed as if 'insertmode' was off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3742 Normal mode remains active until the mapping is finished.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3743 - Use CTRL-L to execute a number of Normal mode commands, then use
477
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 464
diff changeset
3744 <Esc> to get back to Insert mode. Note that CTRL-L moves the cursor
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 464
diff changeset
3745 left, like <Esc> does when 'insertmode' isn't set. |i_CTRL-L|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3746
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3747 These items change when 'insertmode' is set:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3748 - when starting to edit of a file, Vim goes to Insert mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3749 - <Esc> in Insert mode is a no-op and beeps.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3750 - <Esc> in Normal mode makes Vim go to Insert mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3751 - CTRL-L in Insert mode is a command, it is not inserted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3752 - CTRL-Z in Insert mode suspends Vim, see |CTRL-Z|. *i_CTRL-Z*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3753 However, when <Esc> is used inside a mapping, it behaves like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3754 'insertmode' was not set. This was done to be able to use the same
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3755 mappings with 'insertmode' set or not set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3756 When executing commands with |:normal| 'insertmode' is not used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3757
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3758 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3759
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3760 *'isfname'* *'isf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3761 'isfname' 'isf' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3762 "@,48-57,/,\,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,{,},[,],:,@-@,!,~,="
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3763 for AMIGA: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,$,:"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3764 for VMS: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,<,>,[,],:,;,~"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3765 for OS/390: "@,240-249,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,="
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3766 otherwise: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3767 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3768 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3769 The characters specified by this option are included in file names and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3770 path names. Filenames are used for commands like "gf", "[i" and in
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3771 the tags file. It is also used for "\f" in a |pattern|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3772 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3773 characters up to 255 are specified with this option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3774 For UTF-8 the characters 0xa0 to 0xff are included as well.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3775
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3776 Note that on systems using a backslash as path separator, Vim tries to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3777 do its best to make it work as you would expect. That is a bit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3778 tricky, since Vi originally used the backslash to escape special
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3779 characters. Vim will not remove a backslash in front of a normal file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3780 name character on these systems, but it will on Unix and alikes. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3781 '&' and '^' are not included by default, because these are special for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3782 cmd.exe.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3783
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3784 The format of this option is a list of parts, separated with commas.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3785 Each part can be a single character number or a range. A range is two
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3786 character numbers with '-' in between. A character number can be a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3787 decimal number between 0 and 255 or the ASCII character itself (does
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3788 not work for digits). Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3789 "_,-,128-140,#-43" (include '_' and '-' and the range
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3790 128 to 140 and '#' to 43)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3791 If a part starts with '^', the following character number or range
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3792 will be excluded from the option. The option is interpreted from left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3793 to right. Put the excluded character after the range where it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3794 included. To include '^' itself use it as the last character of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3795 option or the end of a range. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3796 "^a-z,#,^" (exclude 'a' to 'z', include '#' and '^')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3797 If the character is '@', all characters where isalpha() returns TRUE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3798 are included. Normally these are the characters a to z and A to Z,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3799 plus accented characters. To include '@' itself use "@-@". Examples:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3800 "@,^a-z" All alphabetic characters, excluding lower
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3801 case letters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3802 "a-z,A-Z,@-@" All letters plus the '@' character.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3803 A comma can be included by using it where a character number is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3804 expected. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3805 "48-57,,,_" Digits, comma and underscore.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3806 A comma can be excluded by prepending a '^'. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3807 " -~,^,,9" All characters from space to '~', excluding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3808 comma, plus <Tab>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3809 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3810
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3811 *'isident'* *'isi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3812 'isident' 'isi' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3813 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3814 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3815 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3816 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3817 The characters given by this option are included in identifiers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3818 Identifiers are used in recognizing environment variables and after a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3819 match of the 'define' option. It is also used for "\i" in a
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
3820 |pattern|. See 'isfname' for a description of the format of this
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3821 option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3822 Careful: If you change this option, it might break expanding
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3823 environment variables. E.g., when '/' is included and Vim tries to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3824 expand "$HOME/.viminfo". Maybe you should change 'iskeyword' instead.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3825
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3826 *'iskeyword'* *'isk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3827 'iskeyword' 'isk' string (Vim default for MS-DOS and Win32:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3828 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3829 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3830 Vi default: "@,48-57,_")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3831 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3832 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3833 Keywords are used in searching and recognizing with many commands:
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3834 "w", "*", "[i", etc. It is also used for "\k" in a |pattern|. See
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3835 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. For C
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3836 programs you could use "a-z,A-Z,48-57,_,.,-,>".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3837 For a help file it is set to all non-blank printable characters except
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3838 '*', '"' and '|' (so that CTRL-] on a command finds the help for that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3839 command).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3840 When the 'lisp' option is on the '-' character is always included.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3841 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3842 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3843
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3844 *'isprint'* *'isp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3845 'isprint' 'isp' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32, OS/2 and Macintosh:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3846 "@,~-255"; otherwise: "@,161-255")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3847 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3848 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3849 The characters given by this option are displayed directly on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3850 screen. It is also used for "\p" in a |pattern|. The characters from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3851 space (ASCII 32) to '~' (ASCII 126) are always displayed directly,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3852 even when they are not included in 'isprint' or excluded. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3853 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3854
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3855 Non-printable characters are displayed with two characters:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3856 0 - 31 "^@" - "^_"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3857 32 - 126 always single characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3858 127 "^?"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3859 128 - 159 "~@" - "~_"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3860 160 - 254 "| " - "|~"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3861 255 "~?"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3862 When 'encoding' is a Unicode one, illegal bytes from 128 to 255 are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3863 displayed as <xx>, with the hexadecimal value of the byte.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3864 When 'display' contains "uhex" all unprintable characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3865 displayed as <xx>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3866 The NonText highlighting will be used for unprintable characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3867 |hl-NonText|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3868
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3869 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3870 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. When a character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3871 is printable but it is not available in the current font, a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3872 replacement character will be shown.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3873 Unprintable and zero-width Unicode characters are displayed as <xxxx>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3874 There is no option to specify these characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3875
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3876 *'joinspaces'* *'js'* *'nojoinspaces'* *'nojs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3877 'joinspaces' 'js' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3878 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3879 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3880 Insert two spaces after a '.', '?' and '!' with a join command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3881 When 'cpoptions' includes the 'j' flag, only do this after a '.'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3882 Otherwise only one space is inserted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3883 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3884
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3885 *'key'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3886 'key' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3887 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3888 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3889 The key that is used for encrypting and decrypting the current buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3890 See |encryption|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3891 Careful: Do not set the key value by hand, someone might see the typed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3892 key. Use the |:X| command. But you can make 'key' empty: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3893 :set key=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3894 < It is not possible to get the value of this option with ":set key" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3895 "echo &key". This is to avoid showing it to someone who shouldn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3896 know. It also means you cannot see it yourself once you have set it,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3897 be careful not to make a typing error!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3898
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3899 *'keymap'* *'kmp'* *E544*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3900 'keymap' 'kmp' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3901 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3902 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3903 {only available when compiled with the |+keymap|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3904 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3905 Name of a keyboard mapping. See |mbyte-keymap|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3906 Setting this option to a valid keymap name has the side effect of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3907 setting 'iminsert' to one, so that the keymap becomes effective.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3908 'imsearch' is also set to one, unless it was -1
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3909 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3910
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3911 *'keymodel'* *'km'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3912 'keymodel' 'km' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3913 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3914 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3915 List of comma separated words, which enable special things that keys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3916 can do. These values can be used:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3917 startsel Using a shifted special key starts selection (either
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3918 Select mode or Visual mode, depending on "key" being
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3919 present in 'selectmode').
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3920 stopsel Using a not-shifted special key stops selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3921 Special keys in this context are the cursor keys, <End>, <Home>,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3922 <PageUp> and <PageDown>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3923 The 'keymodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3924
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3925 *'keywordprg'* *'kp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3926 'keywordprg' 'kp' string (default "man" or "man -s", DOS: ":help",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3927 OS/2: "view /", VMS: "help")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3928 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3929 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3930 Program to use for the |K| command. Environment variables are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3931 expanded |:set_env|. ":help" may be used to access the Vim internal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3932 help. (Note that previously setting the global option to the empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3933 value did this, which is now deprecated.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3934 When "man" is used, Vim will automatically translate a count for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3935 "K" command to a section number. Also for "man -s", in which case the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3936 "-s" is removed when there is no count.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3937 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3938 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3939 :set keywordprg=man\ -s
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3940 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3941 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3942
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3943 *'langmap'* *'lmap'* *E357* *E358*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3944 'langmap' 'lmap' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3945 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3946 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3947 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3948 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3949 This option allows switching your keyboard into a special language
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3950 mode. When you are typing text in Insert mode the characters are
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3951 inserted directly. When in command mode the 'langmap' option takes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3952 care of translating these special characters to the original meaning
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3953 of the key. This means you don't have to change the keyboard mode to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3954 be able to execute Normal mode commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3955 This is the opposite of the 'keymap' option, where characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3956 mapped in Insert mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3957 This only works for 8-bit characters. The value of 'langmap' may be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3958 specified with multi-byte characters (e.g., UTF-8), but only the lower
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3959 8 bits of each character will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3960
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3961 Example (for Greek): *greek* >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3962 :set langmap=ÁA,ÂB,ØC,ÄD,ÅE,ÖF,ÃG,ÇH,ÉI,ÎJ,ÊK,ËL,ÌM,ÍN,ÏO,ÐP,QQ,ÑR,ÓS,ÔT,ÈU,ÙV,WW,×X,ÕY,ÆZ,áa,âb,øc,äd,åe,öf,ãg,çh,éi,îj,êk,ël,ìm,ín,ïo,ðp,qq,ñr,ós,ôt,èu,ùv,òw,÷x,õy,æz
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3963 < Example (exchanges meaning of z and y for commands): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3964 :set langmap=zy,yz,ZY,YZ
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3965 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3966 The 'langmap' option is a list of parts, separated with commas. Each
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3967 part can be in one of two forms:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3968 1. A list of pairs. Each pair is a "from" character immediately
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3969 followed by the "to" character. Examples: "aA", "aAbBcC".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3970 2. A list of "from" characters, a semi-colon and a list of "to"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3971 characters. Example: "abc;ABC"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3972 Example: "aA,fgh;FGH,cCdDeE"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3973 Special characters need to be preceded with a backslash. These are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3974 ";", ',' and backslash itself.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3975
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3976 This will allow you to activate vim actions without having to switch
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3977 back and forth between the languages. Your language characters will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3978 be understood as normal vim English characters (according to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3979 langmap mappings) in the following cases:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3980 o Normal/Visual mode (commands, buffer/register names, user mappings)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3981 o Insert/Replace Mode: Register names after CTRL-R
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3982 o Insert/Replace Mode: Mappings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3983 Characters entered in Command-line mode will NOT be affected by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3984 this option. Note that this option can be changed at any time
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3985 allowing to switch between mappings for different languages/encodings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3986 Use a mapping to avoid having to type it each time!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3987
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3988 *'langmenu'* *'lm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3989 'langmenu' 'lm' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3990 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3991 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3992 {only available when compiled with the |+menu| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3993 |+multi_lang| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3994 Language to use for menu translation. Tells which file is loaded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3995 from the "lang" directory in 'runtimepath': >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3996 "lang/menu_" . &langmenu . ".vim"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3997 < (without the spaces). For example, to always use the Dutch menus, no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3998 matter what $LANG is set to: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3999 :set langmenu=nl_NL.ISO_8859-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4000 < When 'langmenu' is empty, |v:lang| is used.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
4001 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4002 If your $LANG is set to a non-English language but you do want to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4003 the English menus: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4004 :set langmenu=none
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4005 < This option must be set before loading menus, switching on filetype
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4006 detection or syntax highlighting. Once the menus are defined setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4007 this option has no effect. But you could do this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4008 :source $VIMRUNTIME/delmenu.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4009 :set langmenu=de_DE.ISO_8859-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4010 :source $VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4011 < Warning: This deletes all menus that you defined yourself!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4012
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4013 *'laststatus'* *'ls'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4014 'laststatus' 'ls' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4015 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4016 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4017 The value of this option influences when the last window will have a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4018 status line:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4019 0: never
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4020 1: only if there are at least two windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4021 2: always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4022 The screen looks nicer with a status line if you have several
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4023 windows, but it takes another screen line. |status-line|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4024
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4025 *'lazyredraw'* *'lz'* *'nolazyredraw'* *'nolz'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4026 'lazyredraw' 'lz' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4027 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4028 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4029 When this option is set, the screen will not be redrawn while
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4030 executing macros, registers and other commands that have not been
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4031 typed. Also, updating the window title is postponed. To force an
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4032 update use |:redraw|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4033
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4034 *'linebreak'* *'lbr'* *'nolinebreak'* *'nolbr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4035 'linebreak' 'lbr' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4036 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4037 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4038 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4039 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4040 If on Vim will wrap long lines at a character in 'breakat' rather
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4041 than at the last character that fits on the screen. Unlike
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4042 'wrapmargin' and 'textwidth', this does not insert <EOL>s in the file,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4043 it only affects the way the file is displayed, not its contents. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4044 value of 'showbreak' is used to put in front of wrapped lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4045 This option is not used when the 'wrap' option is off or 'list' is on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4046 Note that <Tab> characters after an <EOL> are mostly not displayed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4047 with the right amount of white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4048
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4049 *'lines'* *E593*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4050 'lines' number (default 24 or terminal height)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4051 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4052 Number of lines of the Vim window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4053 Normally you don't need to set this. It is done automatically by the
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
4054 terminal initialization code. Also see |posix-screen-size|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4055 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4056 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4057 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4058 Vim limits the number of lines to what fits on the screen. You can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4059 use this command to get the tallest window possible: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4060 :set lines=999
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4061 < If you get less lines than expected, check the 'guiheadroom' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4062 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4063 number of lines of the display, the display may be messed up.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4064
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4065 *'linespace'* *'lsp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4066 'linespace' 'lsp' number (default 0, 1 for Win32 GUI)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4067 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4068 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4069 {only in the GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4070 Number of pixel lines inserted between characters. Useful if the font
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4071 uses the full character cell height, making lines touch each other.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4072 When non-zero there is room for underlining.
180
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4073 With some fonts there can be too much room between lines (to have
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4074 space for ascents and descents). Then it makes sense to set
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4075 'linespace' to a negative value. This may cause display problems
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4076 though!
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4077
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4078 *'lisp'* *'nolisp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4079 'lisp' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4080 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4081 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4082 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4083 Lisp mode: When <Enter> is typed in insert mode set the indent for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4084 the next line to Lisp standards (well, sort of). Also happens with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4085 "cc" or "S". 'autoindent' must also be on for this to work. The 'p'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4086 flag in 'cpoptions' changes the method of indenting: Vi compatible or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4087 better. Also see 'lispwords'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4088 The '-' character is included in keyword characters. Redefines the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4089 "=" operator to use this same indentation algorithm rather than
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4090 calling an external program if 'equalprg' is empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4091 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4092 {Vi: Does it a little bit differently}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4093
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4094 *'lispwords'* *'lw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4095 'lispwords' 'lw' string (default is very long)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4096 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4097 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4098 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4099 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4100 Comma separated list of words that influence the Lisp indenting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4101 |'lisp'|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4102
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4103 *'list'* *'nolist'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4104 'list' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4105 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4106 List mode: Show tabs as CTRL-I, show end of line with $. Useful to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4107 see the difference between tabs and spaces and for trailing blanks.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4108 Note that this will also affect formatting (set with 'textwidth' or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4109 'wrapmargin') when 'cpoptions' includes 'L'. See 'listchars' for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4110 changing the way tabs are displayed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4111
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4112 *'listchars'* *'lcs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4113 'listchars' 'lcs' string (default "eol:$")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4114 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4115 {not in Vi}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4116 Strings to use in 'list' mode. It is a comma separated list of string
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4117 settings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4118 eol:c Character to show at the end of each line. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4119 omitted, there is no extra character at the end of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4120 line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4121 tab:xy Two characters to be used to show a Tab. The first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4122 char is used once. The second char is repeated to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4123 fill the space that the Tab normally occupies.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4124 "tab:>-" will show a Tab that takes four spaces as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4125 ">---". When omitted, a Tab is show as ^I.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4126 trail:c Character to show for trailing spaces. When omitted,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4127 trailing spaces are blank.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4128 extends:c Character to show in the last column, when 'wrap' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4129 off and the line continues beyond the right of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4130 screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4131 precedes:c Character to show in the first column, when 'wrap'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4132 is off and there is text preceding the character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4133 visible in the first column.
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4134 nbsp:c Character to show for a non-breakable space (character
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4135 0xA0, 160). Left blank when omitted.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4136
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4137 The characters ':' and ',' should not be used. UTF-8 characters can
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4138 be used when 'encoding' is "utf-8", otherwise only printable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4139 characters are allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4140
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4141 Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4142 :set lcs=tab:>-,trail:-
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
4143 :set lcs=tab:>-,eol:<,nbsp:%
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4144 :set lcs=extends:>,precedes:<
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4145 < The "NonText" highlighting will be used for "eol", "extends" and
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
4146 "precedes". "SpecialKey" for "nbsp", "tab" and "trail".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4147
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4148 *'lpl'* *'nolpl'* *'loadplugins'* *'noloadplugins'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4149 'loadplugins' 'lpl' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4150 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4151 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4152 When on the plugin scripts are loaded when starting up |load-plugins|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4153 This option can be reset in your |vimrc| file to disable the loading
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4154 of plugins.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4155 Note that using the "-u NONE" and "--noplugin" command line arguments
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4156 reset this option. |-u| |--noplugin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4157
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4158 *'magic'* *'nomagic'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4159 'magic' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4160 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4161 Changes the special characters that can be used in search patterns.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4162 See |pattern|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4163 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with using patterns, always keep
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4164 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4165 old Vi scripts. In any other situation write patterns that work when
20
4ac1dce8dd5e updated for version 7.0012
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
4166 'magic' is on. Include "\M" when you want to |/\M|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4167
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4168 *'makeef'* *'mef'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4169 'makeef' 'mef' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4170 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4171 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4172 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4173 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4174 Name of the errorfile for the |:make| command (see |:make_makeprg|)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4175 and the |:grep| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4176 When it is empty, an internally generated temp file will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4177 When "##" is included, it is replaced by a number to make the name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4178 unique. This makes sure that the ":make" command doesn't overwrite an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4179 existing file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4180 NOT used for the ":cf" command. See 'errorfile' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4181 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4182 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4183 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4184 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4185
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4186 *'makeprg'* *'mp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4187 'makeprg' 'mp' string (default "make", VMS: "MMS")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4188 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4189 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4190 Program to use for the ":make" command. See |:make_makeprg|. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4191 option may contain '%' and '#' characters, which are expanded like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4192 when used in a command-line. Environment variables are expanded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4193 |:set_env|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4194 backslashes. Note that a '|' must be escaped twice: once for ":set"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4195 and once for the interpretation of a command. When you use a filter
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4196 called "myfilter" do it like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4197 :set makeprg=gmake\ \\\|\ myfilter
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4198 < The placeholder "$*" can be given (even multiple times) to specify
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4199 where the arguments will be included, for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4200 :set makeprg=latex\ \\\\nonstopmode\ \\\\input\\{$*}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4201 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4202 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4203
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4204 *'matchpairs'* *'mps'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4205 'matchpairs' 'mps' string (default "(:),{:},[:]")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4206 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4207 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4208 Characters that form pairs. The |%| command jumps from one to the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4209 other. Currently only single character pairs are allowed, and they
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4210 must be different. The characters must be separated by a colon. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4211 pairs must be separated by a comma. Example for including '<' and '>'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4212 (HTML): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4213 :set mps+=<:>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4214
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4215 < A more exotic example, to jump between the '=' and ';' in an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4216 assignment, useful for languages like C and Java: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4217 :au FileType c,cpp,java set mps+==:;
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4218
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4219 < For a more advanced way of using "%", see the matchit.vim plugin in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4220 the $VIMRUNTIME/macros directory. |add-local-help|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4221
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4222 *'matchtime'* *'mat'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4223 'matchtime' 'mat' number (default 5)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4224 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4225 {not in Vi}{in Nvi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4226 Tenths of a second to show the matching paren, when 'showmatch' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4227 set. Note that this is not in milliseconds, like other options that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4228 set a time. This is to be compatible with Nvi.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4229
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4230 *'maxfuncdepth'* *'mfd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4231 'maxfuncdepth' 'mfd' number (default 100)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4232 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4233 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4234 Maximum depth of function calls for user functions. This normally
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4235 catches endless recursion. When using a recursive function with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4236 more depth, set 'maxfuncdepth' to a bigger number. But this will use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4237 more memory, there is the danger of failing when memory is exhausted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4238 See also |:function|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4239
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4240 *'maxmapdepth'* *'mmd'* *E223*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4241 'maxmapdepth' 'mmd' number (default 1000)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4242 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4243 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4244 Maximum number of times a mapping is done without resulting in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4245 character to be used. This normally catches endless mappings, like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4246 ":map x y" with ":map y x". It still does not catch ":map g wg",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4247 because the 'w' is used before the next mapping is done. See also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4248 |key-mapping|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4249
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4250 *'maxmem'* *'mm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4251 'maxmem' 'mm' number (default between 256 to 5120 (system
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4252 dependent) or half the amount of memory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4253 available)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4254 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4255 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4256 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for one buffer. When this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4257 limit is reached allocating extra memory for a buffer will cause
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4258 other memory to be freed. Maximum value 2000000. Use this to work
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4259 without a limit. Also see 'maxmemtot'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4260
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4261 *'maxmempattern'* *'mmp'*
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4262 'maxmempattern' 'mmp' number (default 1000)
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4263 global
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4264 {not in Vi}
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4265 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for pattern matching.
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4266 Maximum value 2000000. Use this to work without a limit.
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4267 *E363*
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4268 When Vim runs into the limit it gives an error message mostly behaves
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4269 like CTRL-C was typed.
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4270 Running into the limit often means that the pattern is very
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4271 inefficient or too complex. This may already happen with the pattern
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4272 "\(.\)*" on a very long line. ".*" works much better.
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4273 Vim may run out of memory before hitting the 'maxmempattern' limit.
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4274
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4275 *'maxmemtot'* *'mmt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4276 'maxmemtot' 'mmt' number (default between 2048 and 10240 (system
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4277 dependent) or half the amount of memory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4278 available)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4279 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4280 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4281 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for all buffers together.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4282 Maximum value 2000000. Use this to work without a limit. Also see
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4283 'maxmem'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4284
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4285 *'menuitems'* *'mis'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4286 'menuitems' 'mis' number (default 25)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4287 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4288 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4289 {not available when compiled without the |+menu|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4290 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4291 Maximum number of items to use in a menu. Used for menus that are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4292 generated from a list of items, e.g., the Buffers menu. Changing this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4293 option has no direct effect, the menu must be refreshed first.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4294
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4295 *'mkspellmem'* *'msm'*
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4296 'mkspellmem' 'msm' string (default "460000,2000,500")
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4297 global
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4298 {not in Vi}
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4299 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4300 feature}
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4301 Parameters for |:mkspell|. This tunes when to start compressing the
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4302 word tree. Compression can be slow when there are many words, but
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4303 it's needed to avoid running out of memory. The amount of memory used
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4304 per word depends very much on how similar the words are, that's why
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4305 this tuning is complicated.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4306
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4307 There are three numbers, separated by commas:
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4308 {start},{inc},{added}
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4309
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4310 For most languages the uncompressed word tree fits in memory. {start}
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4311 gives the amount of memory in Kbyte that can be used before any
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4312 compression is done. It should be a bit smaller than the amount of
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4313 memory that is available to Vim.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4314
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4315 When going over the {start} limit the {inc} number specifies the
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4316 amount of memory in Kbyte that can be allocated before another
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4317 compression is done. A low number means compression is done after
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4318 less words are added, which is slow. A high number means more memory
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4319 will be allocated.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4320
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4321 After doing compression, {added} times 1024 words can be added before
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4322 the {inc} limit is ignored and compression is done when any extra
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4323 amount of memory is needed. A low number means there is a smaller
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4324 chance of hitting the {inc} limit, less memory is used but it's
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4325 slower.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4326
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4327 The languages for which these numbers are important are Italian and
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4328 Hungarian. The default works for when you have about 512 Mbyte. If
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4329 you have 1 Gbyte you could use: >
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4330 :set mkspellmem=900000,3000,800
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4331 < If you have less than 512 Mbyte |:mkspell| may fail for some
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4332 languages, no matter what you set 'mkspellmem' to.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4333
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4334 *'modeline'* *'ml'* *'nomodeline'* *'noml'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4335 'modeline' 'ml' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4336 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4337 *'modelines'* *'mls'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4338 'modelines' 'mls' number (default 5)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4339 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4340 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4341 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4342 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4343 no lines are checked. See |modeline|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4344 NOTE: 'modeline' is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4345 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4346
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4347 *'modifiable'* *'ma'* *'nomodifiable'* *'noma'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4348 'modifiable' 'ma' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4349 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4350 {not in Vi} *E21*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4351 When off the buffer contents cannot be changed. The 'fileformat' and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4352 'fileencoding' options also can't be changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4353 Can be reset with the |-M| command line argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4354
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4355 *'modified'* *'mod'* *'nomodified'* *'nomod'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4356 'modified' 'mod' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4357 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4358 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4359 When on, the buffer is considered to be modified. This option is set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4360 when:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4361 1. A change was made to the text since it was last written. Using the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4362 |undo| command to go back to the original text will reset the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4363 option. But undoing changes that were made before writing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4364 buffer will set the option again, since the text is different from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4365 when it was written.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4366 2. 'fileformat' or 'fileencoding' is different from its original
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4367 value. The original value is set when the buffer is read or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4368 written. A ":set nomodified" command also resets the original
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4369 values to the current values and the 'modified' option will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4370 reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4371 When 'buftype' is "nowrite" or "nofile" this option may be set, but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4372 will be ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4373
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4374 *'more'* *'nomore'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4375 'more' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4376 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4377 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4378 When on, listings pause when the whole screen is filled. You will get
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4379 the |more-prompt|. When this option is off there are no pauses, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4380 listing continues until finished.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4381 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4382 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4383
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4384 *'mouse'* *E538*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4385 'mouse' string (default "", "a" for GUI, MS-DOS and Win32)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4386 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4387 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4388 Enable the use of the mouse. Only works for certain terminals
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4389 (xterm, MS-DOS, Win32 |win32-mouse|, QNX pterm, and Linux console
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4390 with gpm). For using the mouse in the GUI, see |gui-mouse|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4391 The mouse can be enabled for different modes:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4392 n Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4393 v Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4394 i Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4395 c Command-line mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4396 h all previous modes when editing a help file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4397 a all previous modes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4398 r for |hit-enter| and |more-prompt| prompt
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4399 Normally you would enable the mouse in all four modes with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4400 :set mouse=a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4401 < When the mouse is not enabled, the GUI will still use the mouse for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4402 modeless selection. This doesn't move the text cursor.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4403
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4404 See |mouse-using|. Also see |'clipboard'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4405
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4406 Note: When enabling the mouse in a terminal, copy/paste will use the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4407 "* register if there is access to an X-server. The xterm handling of
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4408 the mouse buttons can still be used by keeping the shift key pressed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4409 Also see the 'clipboard' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4410
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4411 *'mousefocus'* *'mousef'* *'nomousefocus'* *'nomousef'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4412 'mousefocus' 'mousef' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4413 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4414 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4415 {only works in the GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4416 The window that the mouse pointer is on is automatically activated.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4417 When changing the window layout or window focus in another way, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4418 mouse pointer is moved to the window with keyboard focus. Off is the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4419 default because it makes using the pull down menus a little goofy, as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4420 a pointer transit may activate a window unintentionally.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4421
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4422 *'mousehide'* *'mh'* *'nomousehide'* *'nomh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4423 'mousehide' 'mh' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4424 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4425 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4426 {only works in the GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4427 When on, the mouse pointer is hidden when characters are typed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4428 The mouse pointer is restored when the mouse is moved.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4429
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4430 *'mousemodel'* *'mousem'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4431 'mousemodel' 'mousem' string (default "extend", "popup" for MS-DOS and Win32)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4432 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4433 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4434 Sets the model to use for the mouse. The name mostly specifies what
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4435 the right mouse button is used for:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4436 extend Right mouse button extends a selection. This works
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4437 like in an xterm.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4438 popup Right mouse button pops up a menu. The shifted left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4439 mouse button extends a selection. This works like
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
4440 with Microsoft Windows.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4441 popup_setpos Like "popup", but the cursor will be moved to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4442 position where the mouse was clicked, and thus the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4443 selected operation will act upon the clicked object.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4444 If clicking inside a selection, that selection will
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
4445 be acted upon, i.e. no cursor move. This implies of
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4446 course, that right clicking outside a selection will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4447 end Visual mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4448 Overview of what button does what for each model:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4449 mouse extend popup(_setpos) ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4450 left click place cursor place cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4451 left drag start selection start selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4452 shift-left search word extend selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4453 right click extend selection popup menu (place cursor)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4454 right drag extend selection -
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4455 middle click paste paste
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4456
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4457 In the "popup" model the right mouse button produces a pop-up menu.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4458 You need to define this first, see |popup-menu|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4459
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4460 Note that you can further refine the meaning of buttons with mappings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4461 See |gui-mouse-mapping|. But mappings are NOT used for modeless
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4462 selection (because that's handled in the GUI code directly).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4463
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4464 The 'mousemodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4465
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4466 *'mouseshape'* *'mouses'* *E547*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4467 'mouseshape' 'mouses' string (default "i:beam,r:beam,s:updown,sd:cross,
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
4468 m:no,ml:up-arrow,v:rightup-arrow")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4469 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4470 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4471 {only available when compiled with the |+mouseshape|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4472 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4473 This option tells Vim what the mouse pointer should look like in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4474 different modes. The option is a comma separated list of parts, much
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4475 like used for 'guicursor'. Each part consist of a mode/location-list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4476 and an argument-list:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4477 mode-list:shape,mode-list:shape,..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4478 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes/locations:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4479 In a normal window: ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4480 n Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4481 v Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4482 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4483 if not specified)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4484 o Operator-pending mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4485 i Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4486 r Replace mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4487
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4488 Others: ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4489 c appending to the command-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4490 ci inserting in the command-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4491 cr replacing in the command-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4492 m at the 'Hit ENTER' or 'More' prompts
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4493 ml idem, but cursor in the last line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4494 e any mode, pointer below last window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4495 s any mode, pointer on a status line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4496 sd any mode, while dragging a status line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4497 vs any mode, pointer on a vertical separator line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4498 vd any mode, while dragging a vertical separator line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4499 a everywhere
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4500
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4501 The shape is one of the following:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4502 avail name looks like ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4503 w x arrow Normal mouse pointer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4504 w x blank no pointer at all (use with care!)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4505 w x beam I-beam
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4506 w x updown up-down sizing arrows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4507 w x leftright left-right sizing arrows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4508 w x busy The system's usual busy pointer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4509 w x no The system's usual 'no input' pointer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4510 x udsizing indicates up-down resizing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4511 x lrsizing indicates left-right resizing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4512 x crosshair like a big thin +
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4513 x hand1 black hand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4514 x hand2 white hand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4515 x pencil what you write with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4516 x question big ?
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4517 x rightup-arrow arrow pointing right-up
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4518 w x up-arrow arrow pointing up
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4519 x <number> any X11 pointer number (see X11/cursorfont.h)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4520
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4521 The "avail" column contains a 'w' if the shape is available for Win32,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4522 x for X11.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4523 Any modes not specified or shapes not available use the normal mouse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4524 pointer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4525
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4526 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4527 :set mouseshape=s:udsizing,m:no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4528 < will make the mouse turn to a sizing arrow over the status lines and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4529 indicate no input when the hit-enter prompt is displayed (since
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4530 clicking the mouse has no effect in this state.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4531
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4532 *'mousetime'* *'mouset'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4533 'mousetime' 'mouset' number (default 500)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4534 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4535 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4536 Only for GUI, MS-DOS, Win32 and Unix with xterm. Defines the maximum
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4537 time in msec between two mouse clicks for the second click to be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4538 recognized as a multi click.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4539
14
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4540 *'mzquantum'* *'mzq'*
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4541 'mzquantum' 'mzq' number (default 100)
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4542 global
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4543 {not in Vi}
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4544 {not available when compiled without the |+mzscheme|
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4545 feature}
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4546 The number of milliseconds between polls for MzScheme threads.
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4547 Negative or zero value means no thread scheduling.
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4548
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4549 *'nrformats'* *'nf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4550 'nrformats' 'nf' string (default "octal,hex")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4551 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4552 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4553 This defines what bases Vim will consider for numbers when using the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4554 CTRL-A and CTRL-X commands for adding to and subtracting from a number
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4555 respectively; see |CTRL-A| for more info on these commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4556 alpha if included, single alphabetical characters will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4557 incremented or decremented. This is useful for a list with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4558 letter index a), b), etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4559 octal if included, numbers that start with a zero will be considered
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4560 to be octal. Example: Using CTRL-A on "007" results in "010".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4561 hex if included, numbers starting with "0x" or "0X" will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4562 considered to be hexadecimal. Example: Using CTRL-X on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4563 "0x100" results in "0x0ff".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4564 Numbers which simply begin with a digit in the range 1-9 are always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4565 considered decimal. This also happens for numbers that are not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4566 recognized as octal or hex.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4567
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4568 *'number'* *'nu'* *'nonumber'* *'nonu'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4569 'number' 'nu' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4570 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4571 Print the line number in front of each line. When the 'n' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4572 excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped line will not use the column of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4573 line numbers (this is the default when 'compatible' isn't set).
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4574 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4575 number.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4576 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4577 characters are put before the number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4578 See |hl-LineNr| for the highlighting used for the number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4579
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4580 *'numberwidth'* *'nuw'*
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4581 'numberwidth' 'nuw' number (Vim default: 4 Vi default: 8)
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4582 local to window
14
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4583 {not in Vi}
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4584 {only available when compiled with the |+linebreak|
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4585 feature}
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4586 Minimal number of columns to use for the line number. Only relevant
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4587 when the 'number' option is set.
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4588 Since one space is always between the number and the text, there is
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4589 one less character for the number itself.
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4590 The value is the minimum width. A bigger width is used when needed to
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4591 fit the highest line number in the buffer. Thus with the Vim default
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4592 of 4 there is room for a line number up to 999. When the buffer has
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4593 1000 lines five columns will be used.
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4594 The minimum value is 1, the maximum value is 10.
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4595 NOTE: 'numberwidth' is reset to 8 when 'compatible' is set.
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4596
502
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4597 *'occultfunc'* *'ofu'*
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4598 'occultfunc' 'ofu' string (default: empty)
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4599 local to buffer
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4600 {not in Vi}
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4601 {not available when compiled without the +eval
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4602 or +insert_expand feature}
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4603 This option specifies a function to be used for CTRL-X CTRL-O
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4604 completion. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-O|
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4605
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4606 For the use of the function see 'completefunc'.
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4607
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4608
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4609 *'osfiletype'* *'oft'* *E366*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4610 'osfiletype' 'oft' string (RISC-OS default: "Text",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4611 others default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4612 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4613 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4614 {only available when compiled with the |+osfiletype|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4615 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4616 Some operating systems store extra information about files besides
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4617 name, datestamp and permissions. This option contains the extra
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4618 information, the nature of which will vary between systems.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4619 The value of this option is usually set when the file is loaded, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4620 use to set the file type when file is written.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4621 It can affect the pattern matching of the automatic commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4622 |autocmd-osfiletypes|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4623
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4624 *'paragraphs'* *'para'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4625 'paragraphs' 'para' string (default "IPLPPPQPP LIpplpipbp")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4626 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4627 Specifies the nroff macros that separate paragraphs. These are pairs
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4628 of two letters (see |object-motions|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4629
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4630 *'paste'* *'nopaste'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4631 'paste' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4632 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4633 {not in Vi}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4634 Put Vim in Paste mode. This is useful if you want to cut or copy
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4635 some text from one window and paste it in Vim. This will avoid
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4636 unexpected effects.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4637 Setting this option is useful when using Vim in a terminal, where Vim
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4638 cannot distinguish between typed text and pasted text. In the GUI, Vim
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4639 knows about pasting and will mostly do the right thing without 'paste'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4640 being set. The same is true for a terminal where Vim handles the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4641 mouse clicks itself.
148
72aefd4c1e0d updated for version 7.0046
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
4642 This option is reset when starting the GUI. Thus if you set it in
72aefd4c1e0d updated for version 7.0046
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
4643 your .vimrc it will work in a terminal, but not in the GUI. Setting
72aefd4c1e0d updated for version 7.0046
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
4644 'paste' in the GUI has side effects: e.g., the Paste toolbar button
72aefd4c1e0d updated for version 7.0046
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
4645 will no longer work in Insert mode, because it uses a mapping.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4646 When the 'paste' option is switched on (also when it was already on):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4647 - mapping in Insert mode and Command-line mode is disabled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4648 - abbreviations are disabled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4649 - 'textwidth' is set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4650 - 'wrapmargin' is set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4651 - 'autoindent' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4652 - 'smartindent' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4653 - 'softtabstop' is set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4654 - 'revins' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4655 - 'ruler' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4656 - 'showmatch' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4657 - 'formatoptions' is used like it is empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4658 These options keep their value, but their effect is disabled:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4659 - 'lisp'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4660 - 'indentexpr'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4661 - 'cindent'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4662 NOTE: When you start editing another file while the 'paste' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4663 on, settings from the modelines or autocommands may change the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4664 settings again, causing trouble when pasting text. You might want to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4665 set the 'paste' option again.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4666 When the 'paste' option is reset the mentioned options are restored to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4667 the value before the moment 'paste' was switched from off to on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4668 Resetting 'paste' before ever setting it does not have any effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4669 Since mapping doesn't work while 'paste' is active, you need to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4670 the 'pastetoggle' option to toggle the 'paste' option with some key.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4671
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4672 *'pastetoggle'* *'pt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4673 'pastetoggle' 'pt' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4674 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4675 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4676 When non-empty, specifies the key sequence that toggles the 'paste'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4677 option. This is like specifying a mapping: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4678 :map {keys} :set invpaste<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4679 < Where {keys} is the value of 'pastetoggle'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4680 The difference is that it will work even when 'paste' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4681 'pastetoggle' works in Insert mode and Normal mode, but not in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4682 Command-line mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4683 Mappings are checked first, thus overrule 'pastetoggle'. However,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4684 when 'paste' is on mappings are ignored in Insert mode, thus you can do
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4685 this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4686 :map <F10> :set paste<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4687 :map <F11> :set nopaste<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4688 :imap <F10> <C-O>:set paste<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4689 :imap <F11> <nop>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4690 :set pastetoggle=<F11>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4691 < This will make <F10> start paste mode and <F11> stop paste mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4692 Note that typing <F10> in paste mode inserts "<F10>", since in paste
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4693 mode everything is inserted literally, except the 'pastetoggle' key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4694 sequence.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4695
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4696 *'pex'* *'patchexpr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4697 'patchexpr' 'pex' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4698 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4699 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4700 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4701 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4702 Expression which is evaluated to apply a patch to a file and generate
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4703 the resulting new version of the file. See |diff-patchexpr|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4704
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4705 *'patchmode'* *'pm'* *E206*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4706 'patchmode' 'pm' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4707 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4708 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4709 When non-empty the oldest version of a file is kept. This can be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4710 to keep the original version of a file if you are changing files in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4711 source distribution. Only the first time that a file is written a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4712 copy of the original file will be kept. The name of the copy is the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4713 name of the original file with the string in the 'patchmode' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4714 appended. This option should start with a dot. Use a string like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4715 ".org". 'backupdir' must not be empty for this to work (Detail: The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4716 backup file is renamed to the patchmode file after the new file has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4717 been successfully written, that's why it must be possible to write a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4718 backup file). If there was no file to be backed up, an empty file is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4719 created.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4720 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a patchmode file is not made.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4721 Using 'patchmode' for compressed files appends the extension at the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4722 end (e.g., "file.gz.orig"), thus the resulting name isn't always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4723 recognized as a compressed file.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
4724 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4725
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4726 *'path'* *'pa'* *E343* *E345* *E347*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4727 'path' 'pa' string (default on Unix: ".,/usr/include,,"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4728 on OS/2: ".,/emx/include,,"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4729 other systems: ".,,")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4730 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4731 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4732 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4733 |gf|, [f, ]f, ^Wf, |:find| and other commands, provided that the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4734 being searched for has a relative path (not starting with '/'). The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4735 directories in the 'path' option may be relative or absolute.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4736 - Use commas to separate directory names: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4737 :set path=.,/usr/local/include,/usr/include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4738 < - Spaces can also be used to separate directory names (for backwards
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4739 compatibility with version 3.0). To have a space in a directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4740 name, precede it with an extra backslash, and escape the space: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4741 :set path=.,/dir/with\\\ space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4742 < - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with an extra
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4743 backslash: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4744 :set path=.,/dir/with\\,comma
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4745 < - To search relative to the directory of the current file, use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4746 :set path=.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4747 < - To search in the current directory use an empty string between two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4748 commas: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4749 :set path=,,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4750 < - A directory name may end in a ':' or '/'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4751 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4752 - When using |netrw.vim| URLs can be used. For example, adding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4753 "http://www.vim.org" will make ":find index.html" work.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4754 - Search upwards and downwards in a directory tree:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4755 1) "*" matches a sequence of characters, e.g.: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4756 :set path=/usr/include/*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4757 < means all subdirectories in /usr/include (but not /usr/include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4758 itself). >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4759 :set path=/usr/*c
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4760 < matches /usr/doc and /usr/src.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4761 2) "**" matches a subtree, up to 100 directories deep. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4762 :set path=/home/user_x/src/**
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4763 < means search in the whole subtree under "/home/usr_x/src".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4764 3) If the path ends with a ';', this path is the startpoint
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4765 for upward search.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4766 See |file-searching| for more info and exact syntax.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4767 {not available when compiled without the |+path_extra| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4768 - Careful with '\' characters, type two to get one in the option: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4769 :set path=.,c:\\include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4770 < Or just use '/' instead: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4771 :set path=.,c:/include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4772 < Don't forget "." or files won't even be found in the same directory as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4773 the file!
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4774 The maximum length is limited. How much depends on the system, mostly
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4775 it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4776 You can check if all the include files are found, using the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4777 'path', see |:checkpath|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4778 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4779 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4780 uses another default. To remove the current directory use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4781 :set path-=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4782 < To add the current directory use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4783 :set path+=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4784 < To use an environment variable, you probably need to replace the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4785 separator. Here is an example to append $INCL, in which directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4786 names are separated with a semi-colon: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4787 :let &path = &path . "," . substitute($INCL, ';', ',', 'g')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4788 < Replace the ';' with a ':' or whatever separator is used. Note that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4789 this doesn't work when $INCL contains a comma or white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4790
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4791 *'preserveindent'* *'pi'* *'nopreserveindent'* *'nopi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4792 'preserveindent' 'pi' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4793 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4794 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4795 When changing the indent of the current line, preserve as much of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4796 indent structure as possible. Normally the indent is replaced by a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4797 series of tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4798 enabled, in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4799 means the indent will preserve as many existing characters as possible
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4800 for indenting, and only add additional tabs or spaces as required.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4801 NOTE: When using ">>" multiple times the resulting indent is a mix of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4802 tabs and spaces. You might not like this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4803 NOTE: 'preserveindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4804 Also see 'copyindent'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4805 Use |:retab| to clean up white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4806
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4807 *'previewheight'* *'pvh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4808 'previewheight' 'pvh' number (default 12)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4809 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4810 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4811 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4812 |+quickfix| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4813 Default height for a preview window. Used for |:ptag| and associated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4814 commands. Used for |CTRL-W_}| when no count is given.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4815
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4816 *'previewwindow'* *'nopreviewwindow'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4817 *'pvw'* *'nopvw'* *E590*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4818 'previewwindow' 'pvw' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4819 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4820 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4821 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4822 |+quickfix| feature}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4823 Identifies the preview window. Only one window can have this option
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4824 set. It's normally not set directly, but by using one of the commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4825 |:ptag|, |:pedit|, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4826
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4827 *'printdevice'* *'pdev'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4828 'printdevice' 'pdev' string (default empty)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4829 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4830 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4831 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4832 feature}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4833 The name of the printer to be used for |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4834 See |pdev-option|.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
4835 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
4836 security reasons.
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4837
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4838 *'printencoding'* *'penc'*
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4839 'printencoding' 'penc' String (default empty, except for some systems)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4840 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4841 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4842 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4843 and |+postscript| features}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4844 Sets the character encoding used when printing.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4845 See |penc-option|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4846
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4847 *'printexpr'* *'pexpr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4848 'printexpr' 'pexpr' String (default: see below)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4849 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4850 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4851 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4852 and |+postscript| features}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4853 Expression used to print the PostScript produced with |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4854 See |pexpr-option|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4855
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4856 *'printfont'* *'pfn'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4857 'printfont' 'pfn' string (default "courier")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4858 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4859 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4860 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4861 feature}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4862 The name of the font that will be used for |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4863 See |pfn-option|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4864
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4865 *'printheader'* *'pheader'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4866 'printheader' 'pheader' string (default "%<%f%h%m%=Page %N")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4867 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4868 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4869 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4870 feature}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4871 The format of the header produced in |:hardcopy| output.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4872 See |pheader-option|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4873
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4874 *'printmbcharset'* *'pmbcs'*
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4875 'printmbcharset' 'pmbcs' string (default "")
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4876 global
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4877 {not in Vi}
180
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4878 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|,
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4879 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4880 The CJK character set to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4881 See |pmbcs-option|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4882
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4883 *'printmbfont'* *'pmbfn'*
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4884 'printmbfont' 'pmbfn' string (default "")
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4885 global
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4886 {not in Vi}
180
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4887 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|,
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4888 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4889 List of font names to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4890 See |pmbfn-option|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4891
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4892 *'printoptions'* *'popt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4893 'printoptions' 'popt' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4894 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4895 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4896 {only available when compiled with |+printer| feature}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4897 List of items that control the format of the output of |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4898 See |popt-option|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4899
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
4900 *'prompt'* *'noprompt'*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
4901 'prompt' boolean (default on)
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
4902 global
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
4903 When on a ":" prompt is used in Ex mode.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
4904
140
8ecb0db93e9a updated for version 7.0045
vimboss
parents: 99
diff changeset
4905 *'quoteescape'* *'qe'*
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
4906 'quoteescape' 'qe' string (default "\")
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
4907 local to buffer
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
4908 {not in Vi}
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
4909 The characters that are used to escape quotes in a string. Used for
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
4910 objects like a', a" and a` |a'|.
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
4911 When one of the characters in this option is found inside a string,
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
4912 the following character will be skipped. The default value makes the
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
4913 text "foo\"bar\\" considered to be one string.
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
4914
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4915 *'readonly'* *'ro'* *'noreadonly'* *'noro'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4916 'readonly' 'ro' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4917 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4918 If on, writes fail unless you use a '!'. Protects you from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4919 accidentally overwriting a file. Default on when Vim is started
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4920 in read-only mode ("vim -R") or when the executable is called "view".
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
4921 When using ":w!" the 'readonly' option is reset for the current
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
4922 buffer, unless the 'Z' flag is in 'cpoptions'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4923 {not in Vi:} When using the ":view" command the 'readonly' option is
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
4924 set for the newly edited buffer.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4925
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4926 *'remap'* *'noremap'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4927 'remap' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4928 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4929 Allows for mappings to work recursively. If you do not want this for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4930 a single entry, use the :noremap[!] command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4931
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4932 *'report'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4933 'report' number (default 2)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4934 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4935 Threshold for reporting number of lines changed. When the number of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4936 changed lines is more than 'report' a message will be given for most
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4937 ":" commands. If you want it always, set 'report' to 0.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4938 For the ":substitute" command the number of substitutions is used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4939 instead of the number of lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4940
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4941 *'restorescreen'* *'rs'* *'norestorescreen'* *'nors'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4942 'restorescreen' 'rs' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4943 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4944 {not in Vi} {only in Windows 95/NT console version}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4945 When set, the screen contents is restored when exiting Vim. This also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4946 happens when executing external commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4947
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4948 For non-Windows Vim: You can set or reset the 't_ti' and 't_te'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4949 options in your .vimrc. To disable restoring:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4950 set t_ti= t_te=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4951 To enable restoring (for an xterm):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4952 set t_ti=^[7^[[r^[[?47h t_te=^[[?47l^[8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4953 (Where ^[ is an <Esc>, type CTRL-V <Esc> to insert it)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4954
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4955 *'revins'* *'ri'* *'norevins'* *'nori'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4956 'revins' 'ri' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4957 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4958 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4959 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4960 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4961 Inserting characters in Insert mode will work backwards. See "typing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4962 backwards" |ins-reverse|. This option can be toggled with the CTRL-_
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4963 command in Insert mode, when 'allowrevins' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4964 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' or 'paste' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4965
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4966 *'rightleft'* *'rl'* *'norightleft'* *'norl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4967 'rightleft' 'rl' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4968 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4969 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4970 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4971 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4972 When on, display orientation becomes right-to-left, i.e., characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4973 that are stored in the file appear from the right to the left.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4974 Using this option, it is possible to edit files for languages that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4975 are written from the right to the left such as Hebrew and Arabic.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4976 This option is per window, so it is possible to edit mixed files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4977 simultaneously, or to view the same file in both ways (this is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4978 useful whenever you have a mixed text file with both right-to-left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4979 and left-to-right strings so that both sets are displayed properly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4980 in different windows). Also see |rileft.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4981
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4982 *'rightleftcmd'* *'rlc'* *'norightleftcmd'* *'norlc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4983 'rightleftcmd' 'rlc' string (default "search")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4984 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4985 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4986 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4987 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4988 Each word in this option enables the command line editing to work in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4989 right-to-left mode for a group of commands:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4990
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4991 search "/" and "?" commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4992
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4993 This is useful for languages such as Hebrew, Arabic and Farsi.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4994 The 'rightleft' option must be set for 'rightleftcmd' to take effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4995
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4996 *'ruler'* *'ru'* *'noruler'* *'noru'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4997 'ruler' 'ru' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4998 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4999 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5000 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5001 |+cmdline_info| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5002 Show the line and column number of the cursor position, separated by a
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5003 comma. When there is room, the relative position of the displayed
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5004 text in the file is shown on the far right:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5005 Top first line is visible
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5006 Bot last line is visible
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5007 All first and last line are visible
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5008 45% relative position in the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5009 If 'rulerformat' is set, it will determine the contents of the ruler.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5010 Each window has its own ruler. If a window has a status line, the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5011 ruler is shown there. Otherwise it is shown in the last line of the
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5012 screen. If the statusline is given by 'statusline' (i.e. not empty),
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5013 this option takes precedence over 'ruler' and 'rulerformat'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5014 If the number of characters displayed is different from the number of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5015 bytes in the text (e.g., for a TAB or a multi-byte character), both
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5016 the text column (byte number) and the screen column are shown,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5017 separated with a dash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5018 For an empty line "0-1" is shown.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5019 For an empty buffer the line number will also be zero: "0,0-1".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5020 This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5021 If you don't want to see the ruler all the time but want to know where
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5022 you are, use "g CTRL-G" |g_CTRL-G|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5023 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5024
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5025 *'rulerformat'* *'ruf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5026 'rulerformat' 'ruf' string (default empty)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5027 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5028 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5029 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5030 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5031 When this option is not empty, it determines the content of the ruler
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5032 string, as displayed for the 'ruler' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5033 The format of this option, is like that of 'statusline'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5034 The default ruler width is 17 characters. To make the ruler 15
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5035 characters wide, put "%15(" at the start and "%)" at the end.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5036 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5037 :set rulerformat=%15(%c%V\ %p%%%)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5038 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5039 *'runtimepath'* *'rtp'* *vimfiles*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5040 'runtimepath' 'rtp' string (default:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5041 Unix: "$HOME/.vim,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5042 $VIM/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5043 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5044 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5045 $HOME/.vim/after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5046 Amiga: "home:vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5047 $VIM/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5048 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5049 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5050 home:vimfiles/after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5051 PC, OS/2: "$HOME/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5052 $VIM/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5053 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5054 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5055 $HOME/vimfiles/after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5056 Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5057 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5058 $VIM:vimfiles:after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5059 RISC-OS: "Choices:vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5060 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5061 Choices:vimfiles/after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5062 VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5063 $VIM/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5064 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5065 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5066 sys$login:vimfiles/after")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5067 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5068 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5069 This is a list of directories which will be searched for runtime
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5070 files:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5071 filetype.vim filetypes by file name |new-filetype|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5072 scripts.vim filetypes by file contents |new-filetype-scripts|
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
5073 autoload/ automatically loaded scripts |autoload-functions|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5074 colors/ color scheme files |:colorscheme|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5075 compiler/ compiler files |:compiler|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5076 doc/ documentation |write-local-help|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5077 ftplugin/ filetype plugins |write-filetype-plugin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5078 indent/ indent scripts |indent-expression|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5079 keymap/ key mapping files |mbyte-keymap|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5080 lang/ menu translations |:menutrans|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5081 menu.vim GUI menus |menu.vim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5082 plugin/ plugin scripts |write-plugin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5083 print/ files for printing |postscript-print-encoding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5084 syntax/ syntax files |mysyntaxfile|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5085 tutor/ files for vimtutor |tutor|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5086
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5087 And any other file searched for with the |:runtime| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5088
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5089 The defaults for most systems are setup to search five locations:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5090 1. In your home directory, for your personal preferences.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5091 2. In a system-wide Vim directory, for preferences from the system
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5092 administrator.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5093 3. In $VIMRUNTIME, for files distributed with Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5094 *after-directory*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5095 4. In the "after" directory in the system-wide Vim directory. This is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5096 for the system administrator to overrule or add to the distributed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5097 defaults (rarely needed)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5098 5. In the "after" directory in your home directory. This is for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5099 personal preferences to overrule or add to the distributed defaults
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5100 or system-wide settings (rarely needed).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5101
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5102 Note that, unlike 'path', no wildcards like "**" are allowed. Normal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5103 wildcards are allowed, but can significantly slow down searching for
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5104 runtime files. For speed, use as few items as possible and avoid
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5105 wildcards.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5106 See |:runtime|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5107 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5108 :set runtimepath=~/vimruntime,/mygroup/vim,$VIMRUNTIME
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5109 < This will use the directory "~/vimruntime" first (containing your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5110 personal Vim runtime files), then "/mygroup/vim" (shared between a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5111 group of people) and finally "$VIMRUNTIME" (the distributed runtime
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5112 files).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5113 You probably should always include $VIMRUNTIME somewhere, to use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5114 distributed runtime files. You can put a directory before $VIMRUNTIME
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5115 to find files which replace a distributed runtime files. You can put
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5116 a directory after $VIMRUNTIME to find files which add to distributed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5117 runtime files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5118 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5119 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5120
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5121 *'scroll'* *'scr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5122 'scroll' 'scr' number (default: half the window height)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5123 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5124 Number of lines to scroll with CTRL-U and CTRL-D commands. Will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5125 set to half the number of lines in the window when the window size
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5126 changes. If you give a count to the CTRL-U or CTRL-D command it will
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5127 be used as the new value for 'scroll'. Reset to half the window
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5128 height with ":set scroll=0". {Vi is a bit different: 'scroll' gives
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5129 the number of screen lines instead of file lines, makes a difference
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5130 when lines wrap}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5131
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5132 *'scrollbind'* *'scb'* *'noscrollbind'* *'noscb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5133 'scrollbind' 'scb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5134 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5135 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5136 {not available when compiled without the |+scrollbind|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5137 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5138 See also |scroll-binding|. When this option is set, the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5139 window scrolls as other scrollbind windows (windows that also have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5140 this option set) scroll. This option is useful for viewing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5141 differences between two versions of a file, see 'diff'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5142 See |'scrollopt'| for options that determine how this option should be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5143 interpreted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5144 This option is mostly reset when splitting a window to edit another
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5145 file. This means that ":split | edit file" results in two windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5146 with scroll-binding, but ":split file" does not.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5147
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5148 *'scrolljump'* *'sj'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5149 'scrolljump' 'sj' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5150 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5151 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5152 Minimal number of lines to scroll when the cursor gets off the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5153 screen (e.g., with "j"). Not used for scroll commands (e.g., CTRL-E,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5154 CTRL-D). Useful if your terminal scrolls very slowly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5155 NOTE: This option is set to 1 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5156
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5157 *'scrolloff'* *'so'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5158 'scrolloff' 'so' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5159 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5160 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5161 Minimal number of screen lines to keep above and below the cursor.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5162 This will make some context visible around where you are working. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5163 you set it to a very large value (999) the cursor line will always be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5164 in the middle of the window (except at the start or end of the file or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5165 when long lines wrap).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5166 For scrolling horizontally see 'sidescrolloff'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5167 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5168
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5169 *'scrollopt'* *'sbo'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5170 'scrollopt' 'sbo' string (default "ver,jump")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5171 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5172 {not available when compiled without the |+scrollbind|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5173 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5174 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5175 This is a comma-separated list of words that specifies how
236
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
5176 'scrollbind' windows should behave. 'sbo' stands for ScrollBind
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
5177 Options.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5178 The following words are available:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5179 ver Bind vertical scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5180 hor Bind horizontal scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5181 jump Applies to the offset between two windows for vertical
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5182 scrolling. This offset is the difference in the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5183 displayed line of the bound windows. When moving
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5184 around in a window, another 'scrollbind' window may
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5185 reach a position before the start or after the end of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5186 the buffer. The offset is not changed though, when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5187 moving back the 'scrollbind' window will try to scroll
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5188 to the desired position when possible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5189 When now making that window the current one, two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5190 things can be done with the relative offset:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5191 1. When "jump" is not included, the relative offset is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5192 adjusted for the scroll position in the new current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5193 window. When going back to the other window, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5194 the new relative offset will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5195 2. When "jump" is included, the other windows are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5196 scrolled to keep the same relative offset. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5197 going back to the other window, it still uses the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5198 same relative offset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5199 Also see |scroll-binding|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5200
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5201 *'sections'* *'sect'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5202 'sections' 'sect' string (default "SHNHH HUnhsh")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5203 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5204 Specifies the nroff macros that separate sections. These are pairs of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5205 two letters (See |object-motions|). The default makes a section start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5206 at the nroff macros ".SH", ".NH", ".H", ".HU", ".nh" and ".sh".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5207
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5208 *'secure'* *'nosecure'* *E523*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5209 'secure' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5210 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5211 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5212 When on, ":autocmd", shell and write commands are not allowed in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5213 ".vimrc" and ".exrc" in the current directory and map commands are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5214 displayed. Switch it off only if you know that you will not run into
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5215 problems, or when the 'exrc' option is off. On Unix this option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5216 only used if the ".vimrc" or ".exrc" is not owned by you. This can be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5217 dangerous if the systems allows users to do a "chown". You better set
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5218 'secure' at the end of your ~/.vimrc then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5219 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5220 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5221
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5222 *'selection'* *'sel'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5223 'selection' 'sel' string (default "inclusive")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5224 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5225 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5226 This option defines the behavior of the selection. It is only used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5227 in Visual and Select mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5228 Possible values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5229 value past line inclusive ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5230 old no yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5231 inclusive yes yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5232 exclusive yes no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5233 "past line" means that the cursor is allowed to be positioned one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5234 character past the line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5235 "inclusive" means that the last character of the selection is included
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5236 in an operation. For example, when "x" is used to delete the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5237 selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5238 Note that when "exclusive" is used and selecting from the end
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5239 backwards, you cannot include the last character of a line, when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5240 starting in Normal mode and 'virtualedit' empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5241
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5242 The 'selection' option is set by the |:behave| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5243
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5244 *'selectmode'* *'slm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5245 'selectmode' 'slm' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5246 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5247 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5248 This is a comma separated list of words, which specifies when to start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5249 Select mode instead of Visual mode, when a selection is started.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5250 Possible values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5251 mouse when using the mouse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5252 key when using shifted special keys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5253 cmd when using "v", "V" or CTRL-V
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5254 See |Select-mode|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5255 The 'selectmode' option is set by the |:behave| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5256
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5257 *'sessionoptions'* *'ssop'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5258 'sessionoptions' 'ssop' string (default: "blank,buffers,curdir,folds,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5259 help,options,winsize")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5260 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5261 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5262 {not available when compiled without the +mksession
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5263 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5264 Changes the effect of the |:mksession| command. It is a comma
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5265 separated list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5266 something:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5267 word save and restore ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5268 blank empty windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5269 buffers hidden and unloaded buffers, not just those in windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5270 curdir the current directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5271 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5272 fold options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5273 globals global variables that start with an uppercase letter
75
388f285bda1b updated for version 7.0031
vimboss
parents: 41
diff changeset
5274 and contain at least one lowercase letter. Only
388f285bda1b updated for version 7.0031
vimboss
parents: 41
diff changeset
5275 String and Number types are stored.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5276 help the help window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5277 localoptions options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5278 global values for local options)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5279 options all options and mappings (also global values for local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5280 options)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5281 resize size of the Vim window: 'lines' and 'columns'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5282 sesdir the directory in which the session file is located
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5283 will become the current directory (useful with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5284 projects accessed over a network from different
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5285 systems)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5286 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5287 slashes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5288 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5289 on Windows or DOS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5290 winpos position of the whole Vim window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5291 winsize window sizes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5292
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5293 Don't include both "curdir" and "sesdir".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5294 When "curdir" nor "sesdir" is included, file names are stored with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5295 absolute paths.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5296 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing session files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5297 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5298 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5299
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5300 *'shell'* *'sh'* *E91*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5301 'shell' 'sh' string (default $SHELL or "sh",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5302 MS-DOS and Win32: "command.com" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5303 "cmd.exe", OS/2: "cmd")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5304 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5305 Name of the shell to use for ! and :! commands. When changing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5306 value also check these options: 'shelltype', 'shellpipe', 'shellslash'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5307 'shellredir', 'shellquote', 'shellxquote' and 'shellcmdflag'.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5308 It is allowed to give an argument to the command, e.g. "csh -f".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5309 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5310 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5311 If the name of the shell contains a space, you might need to enclose
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5312 it in quotes. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5313 :set shell=\"c:\program\ files\unix\sh.exe\"\ -f
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5314 < Note the backslash before each quote (to avoid starting a comment) and
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5315 each space (to avoid ending the option value). Also note that the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5316 "-f" is not inside the quotes, because it is not part of the command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5317 name. And Vim automagically recognizes the backslashes that are path
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5318 separators.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5319 For Dos 32 bits (DJGPP), you can set the $DJSYSFLAGS environment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5320 variable to change the way external commands are executed. See the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5321 libc.inf file of DJGPP.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5322 Under MS-Windows, when the executable ends in ".com" it must be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5323 included. Thus setting the shell to "command.com" or "4dos.com"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5324 works, but "command" and "4dos" do not work for all commands (e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5325 filtering).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5326 For unknown reasons, when using "4dos.com" the current directory is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5327 changed to "C:\". To avoid this set 'shell' like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5328 :set shell=command.com\ /c\ 4dos
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5329 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5330 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5331
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5332 *'shellcmdflag'* *'shcf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5333 'shellcmdflag' 'shcf' string (default: "-c", MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5334 does not contain "sh" somewhere: "/c")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5335 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5336 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5337 Flag passed to the shell to execute "!" and ":!" commands; e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5338 "bash.exe -c ls" or "command.com /c dir". For the MS-DOS-like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5339 systems, the default is set according to the value of 'shell', to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5340 reduce the need to set this option by the user. It's not used for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5341 OS/2 (EMX figures this out itself). See |option-backslash| about
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5342 including spaces and backslashes. See |dos-shell|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5343 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5344 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5345
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5346 *'shellpipe'* *'sp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5347 'shellpipe' 'sp' string (default ">", "| tee", "|& tee" or "2>&1| tee")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5348 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5349 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5350 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5351 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5352 String to be used to put the output of the ":make" command in the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5353 error file. See also |:make_makeprg|. See |option-backslash| about
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5354 including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5355 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5356 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5357 of this option).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5358 For the Amiga and MS-DOS the default is ">". The output is directly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5359 saved in a file and not echoed to the screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5360 For Unix the default it "| tee". The stdout of the compiler is saved
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5361 in a file and echoed to the screen. If the 'shell' option is "csh" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5362 "tcsh" after initializations, the default becomes "|& tee". If the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5363 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "zsh" or "bash" the default becomes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5364 "2>&1| tee". This means that stderr is also included.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5365 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5366 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5367 there, the 'shellpipe' option changes automatically, unless it was
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5368 explicitly set before.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5369 When 'shellpipe' is set to an empty string, no redirection of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5370 ":make" output will be done. This is useful if you use a 'makeprg'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5371 that writes to 'makeef' by itself. If you want no piping, but do
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5372 want to include the 'makeef', set 'shellpipe' to a single space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5373 Don't forget to precede the space with a backslash: ":set sp=\ ".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5374 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5375 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5376 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5377 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5378
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5379 *'shellquote'* *'shq'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5380 'shellquote' 'shq' string (default: ""; MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5381 contains "sh" somewhere: "\"")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5382 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5383 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5384 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5385 the "!" and ":!" commands. The redirection is kept outside of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5386 quoting. See 'shellxquote' to include the redirection. It's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5387 probably not useful to set both options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5388 This is an empty string by default. Only known to be useful for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5389 third-party shells on MS-DOS-like systems, such as the MKS Korn Shell
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5390 or bash, where it should be "\"". The default is adjusted according
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5391 the value of 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option by the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5392 user. See |dos-shell|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5393 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5394 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5395
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5396 *'shellredir'* *'srr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5397 'shellredir' 'srr' string (default ">", ">&" or ">%s 2>&1")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5398 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5399 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5400 String to be used to put the output of a filter command in a temporary
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5401 file. See also |:!|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5402 and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5403 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5404 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5405 of this option).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5406 The default is ">". For Unix, if the 'shell' option is "csh", "tcsh"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5407 or "zsh" during initializations, the default becomes ">&". If the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5408 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh" or "bash" the default becomes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5409 ">%s 2>&1". This means that stderr is also included.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5410 For Win32, the Unix checks are done and additionally "cmd" is checked
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5411 for, which makes the default ">%s 2>&1". Also, the same names with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5412 ".exe" appended are checked for.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5413 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5414 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5415 there, the 'shellredir' option changes automatically unless it was
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5416 explicitly set before.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5417 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5418 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5419 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5420 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5421
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5422 *'shellslash'* *'ssl'* *'noshellslash'* *'nossl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5423 'shellslash' 'ssl' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5424 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5425 {not in Vi} {only for MSDOS, MS-Windows and OS/2}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5426 When set, a forward slash is used when expanding file names. This is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5427 useful when a Unix-like shell is used instead of command.com or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5428 cmd.exe. Backward slashes can still be typed, but they are changed to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5429 forward slashes by Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5430 Note that setting or resetting this option has no effect for some
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5431 existing file names, thus this option needs to be set before opening
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5432 any file for best results. This might change in the future.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5433 'shellslash' only works when a backslash can be used as a path
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5434 separator. To test if this is so use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5435 if exists('+shellslash')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5436 <
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5437 *'shelltemp'* *'stmp'* *'noshelltemp'* *'nostmp'*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5438 'shelltemp' 'stmp' boolean (Vi default off, Vim default on)
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5439 global
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5440 {not in Vi}
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5441 When on, use temp files for shell commands. When off use a pipe.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5442 When using a pipe is not possible temp files are used anyway.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5443 Currently a pipe is only supported on Unix. You can check it with: >
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5444 :if has("filterpipe")
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5445 < The advantage of using a pipe is that nobody can read the temp file
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5446 and the 'shell' command does not need to support redirection.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5447 The advantage of using a temp file is that the file type and encoding
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5448 can be detected.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5449 The |FilterReadPre|, |FilterReadPost| and |FilterWritePre|,
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5450 |FilterWritePost| autocommands event are not triggered when
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5451 'shelltemp' is off.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5452
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5453 *'shelltype'* *'st'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5454 'shelltype' 'st' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5455 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5456 {not in Vi} {only for the Amiga}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5457 On the Amiga this option influences the way how the commands work
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5458 which use a shell.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5459 0 and 1: always use the shell
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5460 2 and 3: use the shell only to filter lines
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5461 4 and 5: use shell only for ':sh' command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5462 When not using the shell, the command is executed directly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5463
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5464 0 and 2: use "shell 'shellcmdflag' cmd" to start external commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5465 1 and 3: use "shell cmd" to start external commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5466
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5467 *'shellxquote'* *'sxq'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5468 'shellxquote' 'sxq' string (default: "";
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5469 for Win32, when 'shell' contains "sh"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5470 somewhere: "\""
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5471 for Unix, when using system(): "\"")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5472 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5473 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5474 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5475 the "!" and ":!" commands. Includes the redirection. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5476 'shellquote' to exclude the redirection. It's probably not useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5477 to set both options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5478 This is an empty string by default. Known to be useful for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5479 third-party shells when using the Win32 version, such as the MKS Korn
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5480 Shell or bash, where it should be "\"". The default is adjusted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5481 according the value of 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5482 by the user. See |dos-shell|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5483 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5484 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5485
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5486 *'shiftround'* *'sr'* *'noshiftround'* *'nosr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5487 'shiftround' 'sr' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5488 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5489 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5490 Round indent to multiple of 'shiftwidth'. Applies to > and <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5491 commands. CTRL-T and CTRL-D in Insert mode always round the indent to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5492 a multiple of 'shiftwidth' (this is Vi compatible).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5493 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5494
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5495 *'shiftwidth'* *'sw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5496 'shiftwidth' 'sw' number (default 8)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5497 local to buffer
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5498 Number of spaces to use for each step of (auto)indent. Used for
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5499 |'cindent'|, |>>|, |<<|, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5500
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5501 *'shortmess'* *'shm'*
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5502 'shortmess' 'shm' string (Vim default "filnxtToO", Vi default: "",
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5503 POSIX default: "A")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5504 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5505 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5506 This option helps to avoid all the |hit-enter| prompts caused by file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5507 messages, for example with CTRL-G, and to avoid some other messages.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5508 It is a list of flags:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5509 flag meaning when present ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5510 f use "(3 of 5)" instead of "(file 3 of 5)"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5511 i use "[noeol]" instead of "[Incomplete last line]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5512 l use "999L, 888C" instead of "999 lines, 888 characters"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5513 m use "[+]" instead of "[Modified]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5514 n use "[New]" instead of "[New File]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5515 r use "[RO]" instead of "[readonly]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5516 w use "[w]" instead of "written" for file write message
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5517 and "[a]" instead of "appended" for ':w >> file' command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5518 x use "[dos]" instead of "[dos format]", "[unix]" instead of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5519 "[unix format]" and "[mac]" instead of "[mac format]".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5520 a all of the above abbreviations
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5521
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5522 o overwrite message for writing a file with subsequent message
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5523 for reading a file (useful for ":wn" or when 'autowrite' on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5524 O message for reading a file overwrites any previous message.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5525 Also for quickfix message (e.g., ":cn").
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5526 s don't give "search hit BOTTOM, continuing at TOP" or "search
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5527 hit TOP, continuing at BOTTOM" messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5528 t truncate file message at the start if it is too long to fit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5529 on the command-line, "<" will appear in the left most column.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5530 Ignored in Ex mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5531 T truncate other messages in the middle if they are too long to
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5532 fit on the command line. "..." will appear in the middle.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5533 Ignored in Ex mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5534 W don't give "written" or "[w]" when writing a file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5535 A don't give the "ATTENTION" message when an existing swap file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5536 is found.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5537 I don't give the intro message when starting Vim |:intro|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5538
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5539 This gives you the opportunity to avoid that a change between buffers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5540 requires you to hit <Enter>, but still gives as useful a message as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5541 possible for the space available. To get the whole message that you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5542 would have got with 'shm' empty, use ":file!"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5543 Useful values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5544 shm= No abbreviation of message.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5545 shm=a Abbreviation, but no loss of information.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5546 shm=at Abbreviation, and truncate message when necessary.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5547
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5548 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5549 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5550
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5551 *'shortname'* *'sn'* *'noshortname'* *'nosn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5552 'shortname' 'sn' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5553 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5554 {not in Vi, not in MS-DOS versions}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5555 Filenames are assumed to be 8 characters plus one extension of 3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5556 characters. Multiple dots in file names are not allowed. When this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5557 option is on, dots in file names are replaced with underscores when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5558 adding an extension (".~" or ".swp"). This option is not available
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5559 for MS-DOS, because then it would always be on. This option is useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5560 when editing files on an MS-DOS compatible filesystem, e.g., messydos
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5561 or crossdos. When running the Win32 GUI version under Win32s, this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5562 option is always on by default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5563
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5564 *'showbreak'* *'sbr'* *E595*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5565 'showbreak' 'sbr' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5566 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5567 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5568 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5569 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5570 String to put at the start of lines that have been wrapped. Useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5571 values are "> " or "+++ ".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5572 Only printable single-cell characters are allowed, excluding <Tab> and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5573 comma (in a future version the comma might be used to separate the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5574 part that is shown at the end and at the start of a line).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5575 The characters are highlighted according to the '@' flag in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5576 'highlight'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5577 Note that tabs after the showbreak will be displayed differently.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5578 If you want the 'showbreak' to appear in between line numbers, add the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5579 "n" flag to 'cpoptions'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5580
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5581 *'showcmd'* *'sc'* *'noshowcmd'* *'nosc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5582 'showcmd' 'sc' boolean (Vim default: on, off for Unix, Vi default:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5583 off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5584 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5585 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5586 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5587 |+cmdline_info| feature}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5588 Show (partial) command in status line. Set this option off if your
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5589 terminal is slow.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5590 In Visual mode the size of the selected area is shown:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5591 - When selecting characters within a line, the number of characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5592 - When selecting more than one line, the number of lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5593 - When selecting a block, the size in screen characters: linesxcolumns.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5594 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5595 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5596
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5597 *'showfulltag'* *'sft'* *'noshowfulltag'* *'nosft'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5598 'showfulltag' 'sft' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5599 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5600 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5601 When completing a word in insert mode (see |ins-completion|) from the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5602 tags file, show both the tag name and a tidied-up form of the search
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5603 pattern (if there is one) as possible matches. Thus, if you have
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5604 matched a C function, you can see a template for what arguments are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5605 required (coding style permitting).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5606
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5607 *'showmatch'* *'sm'* *'noshowmatch'* *'nosm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5608 'showmatch' 'sm' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5609 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5610 When a bracket is inserted, briefly jump to the matching one. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5611 jump is only done if the match can be seen on the screen. The time to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5612 show the match can be set with 'matchtime'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5613 A Beep is given if there is no match (no matter if the match can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5614 seen or not). This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5615 When the 'm' flag is not included in 'cpoptions', typing a character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5616 will immediately move the cursor back to where it belongs.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5617 See the "sm" field in 'guicursor' for setting the cursor shape and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5618 blinking when showing the match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5619 The 'matchpairs' option can be used to specify the characters to show
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5620 matches for. 'rightleft' and 'revins' are used to look for opposite
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5621 matches.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5622 Note: For the use of the short form parental guidance is advised.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5623
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5624 *'showmode'* *'smd'* *'noshowmode'* *'nosmd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5625 'showmode' 'smd' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5626 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5627 If in Insert, Replace or Visual mode put a message on the last line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5628 Use the 'M' flag in 'highlight' to set the type of highlighting for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5629 this message.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5630 When |XIM| may be used the message will include "XIM". But this
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5631 doesn't mean XIM is really active, especially when 'imactivatekey' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5632 not set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5633 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5634 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5635
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5636 *'sidescroll'* *'ss'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5637 'sidescroll' 'ss' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5638 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5639 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5640 The minimal number of columns to scroll horizontally. Used only when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5641 the 'wrap' option is off and the cursor is moved off of the screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5642 When it is zero the cursor will be put in the middle of the screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5643 When using a slow terminal set it to a large number or 0. When using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5644 a fast terminal use a small number or 1. Not used for "zh" and "zl"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5645 commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5646
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5647 *'sidescrolloff'* *'siso'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5648 'sidescrolloff' 'siso' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5649 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5650 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5651 The minimal number of screen columns to keep to the left and to the
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5652 right of the cursor if 'nowrap' is set. Setting this option to a value
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5653 greater than 0 while having |'sidescroll'| also at a non-zero value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5654 makes some context visible in the line you are scrolling in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5655 horizontally (except at the end and beginning of the line). Setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5656 this option to a large value (like 999) has the effect of keeping the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5657 cursor horizontally centered in the window, as long as one does not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5658 come too close to the beginning or end of the line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5659 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5660
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5661 Example: Try this together with 'sidescroll' and 'listchars' as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5662 in the following example to never allow the cursor to move
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5663 onto the "extends" character:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5664
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5665 :set nowrap sidescroll=1 listchars=extends:>,precedes:<
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5666 :set sidescrolloff=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5667
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5668
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5669 *'smartcase'* *'scs'* *'nosmartcase'* *'noscs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5670 'smartcase' 'scs' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5671 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5672 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5673 Override the 'ignorecase' option if the search pattern contains upper
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5674 case characters. Only used when the search pattern is typed and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5675 'ignorecase' option is on. Used for the commands "/", "?", "n", "N",
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5676 ":g" and ":s". Not used for "*", "#", "gd", tag search, etc.. After
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5677 "*" and "#" you can make 'smartcase' used by doing a "/" command,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5678 recalling the search pattern from history and hitting <Enter>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5679 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5680
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5681 *'smartindent'* *'si'* *'nosmartindent'* *'nosi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5682 'smartindent' 'si' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5683 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5684 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5685 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5686 |+smartindent| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5687 Do smart autoindenting when starting a new line. Works for C-like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5688 programs, but can also be used for other languages. 'cindent' does
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5689 something like this, works better in most cases, but is more strict,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5690 see |C-indenting|. When 'cindent' is on, setting 'si' has no effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5691 'indentexpr' is a more advanced alternative.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5692 Normally 'autoindent' should also be on when using 'smartindent'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5693 An indent is automatically inserted:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5694 - After a line ending in '{'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5695 - After a line starting with a keyword from 'cinwords'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5696 - Before a line starting with '}' (only with the "O" command).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5697 When typing '}' as the first character in a new line, that line is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5698 given the same indent as the matching '{'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5699 When typing '#' as the first character in a new line, the indent for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5700 that line is removed, the '#' is put in the first column. The indent
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5701 is restored for the next line. If you don't want this, use this
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5702 mapping: ":inoremap # X^H#", where ^H is entered with CTRL-V CTRL-H.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5703 When using the ">>" command, lines starting with '#' are not shifted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5704 right.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5705 NOTE: 'smartindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set. When 'paste'
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5706 is set smart indenting is disabled.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5707
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5708 *'smarttab'* *'sta'* *'nosmarttab'* *'nosta'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5709 'smarttab' 'sta' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5710 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5711 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5712 When on, a <Tab> in front of a line inserts blanks according to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5713 'shiftwidth'. 'tabstop' is used in other places. A <BS> will delete
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5714 a 'shiftwidth' worth of space at the start of the line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5715 When off a <Tab> always inserts blanks according to 'tabstop'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5716 'shiftwidth' is only used for shifting text left or right
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5717 |shift-left-right|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5718 What gets inserted (a Tab or spaces) depends on the 'expandtab'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5719 option. Also see |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the
11
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
5720 number of spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5721 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5722
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5723 *'softtabstop'* *'sts'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5724 'softtabstop' 'sts' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5725 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5726 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5727 Number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while performing editing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5728 operations, like inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5729 <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mix of spaces and <Tab>s is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5730 used. This is useful to keep the 'ts' setting at its standard value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5731 of 8, while being able to edit like it is set to 'sts'. However,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5732 commands like "x" still work on the actual characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5733 When 'sts' is zero, this feature is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5734 'softtabstop' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5735 See also |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the number of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5736 spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5737 The 'L' flag in 'cpoptions' changes how tabs are used when 'list' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5738 set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5739 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5740
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5741 *'spell'* *'nospell'*
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5742 'spell' boolean (default off)
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5743 local to window
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5744 {not in Vi}
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5745 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5746 feature}
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5747 When on spell checking will be done. See |spell|.
236
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
5748 The languages are specified with 'spelllang'.
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5749
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5750 *'spellcapcheck'* *'spc'*
389
4fe8e1a7758e updated for version 7.0102
vimboss
parents: 386
diff changeset
5751 'spellcapcheck' 'spc' string (default "[.?!]\_[\])'" \t]\+")
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5752 local to buffer
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5753 {not in Vi}
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5754 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5755 feature}
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5756 Pattern to locate the end of a sentence. The following word will be
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5757 checked to start with a capital letter. If not then it is highlighted
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
5758 with SpellCap |hl-SpellCap| (unless the word is also badly spelled).
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5759 When this check is not wanted make this option empty.
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5760 Only used when 'spell' is set.
389
4fe8e1a7758e updated for version 7.0102
vimboss
parents: 386
diff changeset
5761 Be careful with special characters, see |option-backslash| about
4fe8e1a7758e updated for version 7.0102
vimboss
parents: 386
diff changeset
5762 including spaces and backslashes.
480
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
5763 To set this option automatically depending on the language, see
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
5764 |set-spc-auto|.
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5765
314
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5766 *'spellfile'* *'spf'*
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5767 'spellfile' 'spf' string (default empty)
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5768 local to buffer
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5769 {not in Vi}
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5770 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5771 feature}
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5772 Name of the word list file where words are added for the |zg| and |zw|
401
4a1ead01d30b updated for version 7.0105
vimboss
parents: 389
diff changeset
5773 commands. It must end in ".{encoding}.add". You need to include the
4a1ead01d30b updated for version 7.0105
vimboss
parents: 389
diff changeset
5774 path, otherwise the file is placed in the current directory.
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5775 *E765*
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5776 It may also be a comma separated list of names. A count before the
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5777 |zg| and |zw| commands can be used to access each. This allows using
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5778 a personal word list file and a project word list file.
314
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5779 When a word is added while this option is empty Vim will set it for
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5780 you: Using the first "spell" directory in 'runtimepath' that is
353
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5781 writable and the first language name that appears in 'spelllang',
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5782 ignoring the region.
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5783 The resulting ".spl" file will be used for spell checking, it does not
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5784 have to appear in 'spelllang'.
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5785 Normally one file is used for all regions, but you can add the region
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5786 name if you want to. However, it will then only be used when
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5787 'spellfile' is set to it, for entries in 'spelllang' only files
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5788 without region name will be found.
336
2d8c2622e1fa updated for version 7.0087
vimboss
parents: 314
diff changeset
5789 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2d8c2622e1fa updated for version 7.0087
vimboss
parents: 314
diff changeset
5790 security reasons.
314
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5791
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5792 *'spelllang'* *'spl'*
314
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5793 'spelllang' 'spl' string (default "en")
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5794 local to buffer
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5795 {not in Vi}
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5796 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5797 feature}
353
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5798 A comma separated list of word list names. When the 'spell' option is
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5799 on spellchecking will be done for these languages. Example: >
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5800 set spelllang=en_us,nl,medical
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5801 < This means US English, Dutch and medical words are recognized. Words
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5802 that are not recognized will be highlighted.
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5803 The word list name must not include a comma or dot. Using a dash is
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5804 recommended to separate the two letter language name from a
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5805 specification. Thus "en-rare" is used for rare English words.
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5806 A region name must come last and have the form "_xx", where "xx" is
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5807 the two-letter, lower case region name. You can use more than one
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5808 region by listing them: "en_us,en_ca" supports both US and Canadian
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5809 English, but not words specific for Australia, New Zealand or Great
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5810 Britain.
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
5811 *E757*
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
5812 As a special case the name of a .spl file can be given as-is. The
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
5813 first "_xx" in the name is removed and used as the region name
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
5814 (_xx is an underscore, two letters and followed by a non-letter).
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
5815 This is mainly for testing purposes. You must make sure the correct
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
5816 encoding is used, Vim doesn't check it.
236
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
5817 When 'encoding' is set the word lists are reloaded. Thus it's a good
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
5818 idea to set 'spelllang' after setting 'encoding' to avoid loading the
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
5819 files twice.
353
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5820 How the related spell files are found is explained here: |spell-load|.
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5821
480
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
5822 After this option has been set successfully, Vim will source the files
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
5823 "spell/LANG.vim" in 'runtimepath'. "LANG" is the value of 'spelllang'
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
5824 up to the first comma, dot or underscore. See |set-spc-auto|.
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
5825
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
5826
344
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
5827 *'spellsuggest'* *'sps'*
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
5828 'spellsuggest' 'sps' string (default "best")
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
5829 global
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
5830 {not in Vi}
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
5831 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
5832 feature}
374
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5833 Methods used for spelling suggestions. Both for the |z?| command and
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5834 the |spellsuggest()| function. This is a comma-separated list of
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5835 items:
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5836
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5837 best Internal method that works best for English. Finds
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5838 changes like "fast" and uses a bit of sound-a-like
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5839 scoring to improve the ordering.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5840
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5841 double Internal method that uses two methods and mixes the
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5842 results. The first method is "fast", the other method
344
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
5843 computes how much the suggestion sounds like the bad
374
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5844 word. That only works when the language specifies
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5845 sound folding. Can be slow and doesn't always give
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5846 better results.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5847
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5848 fast Internal method that only checks for simple changes:
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5849 character inserts/deletes/swaps. Works well for
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5850 simple typing mistakes.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5851
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
5852 {number} The maximum number of suggestions listed for |z?|.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
5853 Not used for |spellsuggest()|. The number of
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
5854 suggestions is never more than the value of 'lines'
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
5855 minus two.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
5856
374
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5857 file:{filename} Read file {filename}, which must have two columns,
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5858 separated by a slash. The first column contains the
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5859 bad word, the second column the suggested good word.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5860 Example:
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5861 theribal/terrible ~
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5862 Use this for common mistakes that do not appear at the
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5863 top of the suggestion list with the internal methods.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5864 Lines without a slash are ignored, use this for
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5865 comments.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5866 The file is used for all languages.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5867
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5868 expr:{expr} Evaluate expression {expr}. Use a function to avoid
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5869 trouble with spaces. |v:val| holds the badly spelled
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5870 word. The expression must evaluate to a List of
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5871 Lists, each with a suggestion and a score.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5872 Example:
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5873 [['the', 33], ['that', 44]]
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5874 Set 'verbose' and use |z?| to see the scores that the
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5875 internal methods use. A lower score is better.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5876 This may invoke |spellsuggest()| if you temporarily
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5877 set 'spellsuggest' to exclude the "expr:" part.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5878 Errors are silently ignored, unless you set the
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5879 'verbose' option to a non-zero value.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5880
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5881 Only one of "best", "double" or "fast" may be used. The others may
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5882 appear several times in any order. Example: >
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5883 :set sps=file:~/.vim/sugg,best,expr:MySuggest()
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5884 <
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5885 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
5886 security reasons.
344
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
5887
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
5888
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5889 *'splitbelow'* *'sb'* *'nosplitbelow'* *'nosb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5890 'splitbelow' 'sb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5891 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5892 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5893 {not available when compiled without the +windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5894 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5895 When on, splitting a window will put the new window below the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5896 one. |:split|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5897
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5898 *'splitright'* *'spr'* *'nosplitright'* *'nospr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5899 'splitright' 'spr' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5900 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5901 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5902 {not available when compiled without the +vertsplit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5903 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5904 When on, splitting a window will put the new window right of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5905 current one. |:vsplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5906
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5907 *'startofline'* *'sol'* *'nostartofline'* *'nosol'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5908 'startofline' 'sol' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5909 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5910 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5911 When "on" the commands listed below move the cursor to the first
11
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
5912 non-blank of the line. When off the cursor is kept in the same column
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5913 (if possible). This applies to the commands: CTRL-D, CTRL-U, CTRL-B,
11
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
5914 CTRL-F, "G", "H", "M", "L", gg, and to the commands "d", "<<" and ">>"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5915 with a linewise operator, with "%" with a count and to buffer changing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5916 commands (CTRL-^, :bnext, :bNext, etc.). Also for an Ex command that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5917 only has a line number, e.g., ":25" or ":+".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5918 In case of buffer changing commands the cursor is placed at the column
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5919 where it was the last time the buffer was edited.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5920 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5921
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5922 *'statusline'* *'stl'* *E540* *E541* *E542*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5923 'statusline' 'stl' string (default empty)
40
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
5924 global or local to window |global-local|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5925 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5926 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5927 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5928 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the status line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5929 Also see |status-line|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5930
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5931 The option consists of printf style '%' items interspersed with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5932 normal text. Each status line item is of the form:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5933 %-0{minwid}.{maxwid}{item}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5934 All fields except the {item} is optional. A single percent sign can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5935 be given as "%%". Up to 80 items can be specified.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5936
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5937 Note that the only effect of 'ruler' when this option is set (and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5938 'laststatus' is 2) is controlling the output of |CTRL-G|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5939
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5940 field meaning ~
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5941 - Left justify the item. The default is right justified
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5942 when minwid is larger than the length of the item.
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5943 0 Leading zeroes in numeric items. Overridden by '-'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5944 minwid Minimum width of the item, padding as set by '-' & '0'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5945 Value must be 50 or less.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5946 maxwid Maximum width of the item. Truncation occurs with a '<'
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5947 on the left for text items. Numeric items will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5948 shifted down to maxwid-2 digits followed by '>'number
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5949 where number is the amount of missing digits, much like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5950 an exponential notation.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5951 item A one letter code as described below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5952
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5953 Following is a description of the possible statusline items. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5954 second character in "item" is the type:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5955 N for number
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5956 S for string
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5957 F for flags as described below
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5958 - not applicable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5959
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5960 item meaning ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5961 f S Path to the file in the buffer, relative to current directory.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5962 F S Full path to the file in the buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5963 t S File name (tail) of file in the buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5964 m F Modified flag, text is " [+]"; " [-]" if 'modifiable' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5965 M F Modified flag, text is ",+" or ",-".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5966 r F Readonly flag, text is " [RO]".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5967 R F Readonly flag, text is ",RO".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5968 h F Help buffer flag, text is " [help]".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5969 H F Help buffer flag, text is ",HLP".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5970 w F Preview window flag, text is " [Preview]".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5971 W F Preview window flag, text is ",PRV".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5972 y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., " [vim]". See 'filetype'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5973 Y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., ",VIM". See 'filetype'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5974 {not available when compiled without |+autocmd| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5975 k S Value of "b:keymap_name" or 'keymap' when |:lmap| mappings are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5976 being used: "<keymap>"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5977 n N Buffer number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5978 b N Value of byte under cursor.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5979 B N As above, in hexadecimal.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5980 o N Byte number in file of byte under cursor, first byte is 1.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5981 Mnemonic: Offset from start of file (with one added)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5982 {not available when compiled without |+byte_offset| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5983 O N As above, in hexadecimal.
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5984 N N Printer page number. (Only works in the 'printheader' option.)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5985 l N Line number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5986 L N Number of lines in buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5987 c N Column number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5988 v N Virtual column number.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5989 V N Virtual column number as -{num}. Not displayed if equal to 'c'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5990 p N Percentage through file in lines as in |CTRL-G|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5991 P S Percentage through file of displayed window. This is like the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5992 percentage described for 'ruler'. Always 3 in length.
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5993 a S Argument list status as in default title. ({current} of {max})
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5994 Empty if the argument file count is zero or one.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5995 { NF Evaluate expression between '{' and '}' and substitute result.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5996 ( - Start of item group. Can be used for setting the width and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5997 alignment of a section. Must be followed by %) somewhere.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5998 ) - End of item group. No width fields allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5999 < - Where to truncate line if too long. Default is at the start.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6000 No width fields allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6001 = - Separation point between left and right aligned items.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6002 No width fields allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6003 * - Set highlight group to User{N}, where {N} is taken from the
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6004 minwid field, e.g. %1*. Restore normal highlight with %* or %0*.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6005 The difference between User{N} and StatusLine will be applied
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6006 to StatusLineNC for the statusline of non-current windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6007 The number N must be between 1 and 9. See |hl-User1..9|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6008
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6009 Display of flags are controlled by the following heuristic:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6010 If a flag text starts with comma it is assumed that it wants to
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6011 separate itself from anything but preceding plaintext. If it starts
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6012 with a space it is assumed that it wants to separate itself from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6013 anything but other flags. That is: A leading comma is removed if the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6014 preceding character stems from plaintext. A leading space is removed
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6015 if the preceding character stems from another active flag. This will
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6016 make a nice display when flags are used like in the examples below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6017
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6018 When all items in a group becomes an empty string (i.e. flags that are
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6019 not set) and a minwid is not set for the group, the whole group will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6020 become empty. This will make a group like the following disappear
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6021 completely from the statusline when none of the flags are set. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6022 :set statusline=...%(\ [%M%R%H]%)...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6023 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6024 Beware that an expression is evaluated each and every time the status
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6025 line is displayed. The current buffer and current window will be set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6026 temporarily to that of the window (and buffer) whose statusline is
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6027 currently being drawn. The expression will evaluate in this context.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6028 The variable "actual_curbuf" is set to the 'bufnr()' number of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6029 real current buffer. The expression is evaluated in the |sandbox|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6030
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6031 If the statusline is not updated when you want it (e.g., after setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6032 a variable that's used in an expression), you can force an update by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6033 setting an option without changing its value. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6034 :let &ro = &ro
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6035
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6036 < A result of all digits is regarded a number for display purposes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6037 Otherwise the result is taken as flag text and applied to the rules
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6038 described above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6039
199
3b32f6b507fa updated for version 7.0059
vimboss
parents: 189
diff changeset
6040 Watch out for errors in expressions. They may render Vim unusable!
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6041 If you are stuck, hold down ':' or 'Q' to get a prompt, then quit and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6042 edit your .vimrc or whatever with "vim -u NONE" to get it right.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6043
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6044 Examples:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6045 Emulate standard status line with 'ruler' set >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6046 :set statusline=%<%f\ %h%m%r%=%-14.(%l,%c%V%)\ %P
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6047 < Similar, but add ASCII value of char under the cursor (like "ga") >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6048 :set statusline=%<%f%h%m%r%=%b\ 0x%B\ \ %l,%c%V\ %P
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6049 < Display byte count and byte value, modified flag in red. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6050 :set statusline=%<%f%=\ [%1*%M%*%n%R%H]\ %-19(%3l,%02c%03V%)%O'%02b'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6051 :hi User1 term=inverse,bold cterm=inverse,bold ctermfg=red
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6052 < Display a ,GZ flag if a compressed file is loaded >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6053 :set statusline=...%r%{VarExists('b:gzflag','\ [GZ]')}%h...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6054 < In the |:autocmd|'s: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6055 :let b:gzflag = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6056 < And: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6057 :unlet b:gzflag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6058 < And define this function: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6059 :function VarExists(var, val)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6060 : if exists(a:var) | return a:val | else | return '' | endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6061 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6062 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6063 *'suffixes'* *'su'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6064 'suffixes' 'su' string (default ".bak,~,.o,.h,.info,.swp,.obj")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6065 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6066 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6067 Files with these suffixes get a lower priority when multiple files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6068 match a wildcard. See |suffixes|. Commas can be used to separate the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6069 suffixes. Spaces after the comma are ignored. A dot is also seen as
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6070 the start of a suffix. To avoid a dot or comma being recognized as a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6071 separator, precede it with a backslash (see |option-backslash| about
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6072 including spaces and backslashes).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6073 See 'wildignore' for completely ignoring files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6074 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6075 suffixes from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6076 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6077
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6078 *'suffixesadd'* *'sua'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6079 'suffixesadd' 'sua' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6080 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6081 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6082 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6083 |+file_in_path| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6084 Comma separated list of suffixes, which are used when searching for a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6085 file for the "gf", "[I", etc. commands. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6086 :set suffixesadd=.java
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6087 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6088 *'swapfile'* *'swf'* *'noswapfile'* *'noswf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6089 'swapfile' 'swf' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6090 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6091 {not in Vi}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6092 Use a swapfile for the buffer. This option can be reset when a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6093 swapfile is not wanted for a specific buffer. For example, with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6094 confidential information that even root must not be able to access.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6095 Careful: All text will be in memory:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6096 - Don't use this for big files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6097 - Recovery will be impossible!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6098 A swapfile will only be present when |'updatecount'| is non-zero and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6099 'swapfile' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6100 When 'swapfile' is reset, the swap file for the current buffer is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6101 immediately deleted. When 'swapfile' is set, and 'updatecount' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6102 non-zero, a swap file is immediately created.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6103 Also see |swap-file| and |'swapsync'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6104
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6105 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'buftype' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6106 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6107
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6108 *'swapsync'* *'sws'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6109 'swapsync' 'sws' string (default "fsync")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6110 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6111 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6112 When this option is not empty a swap file is synced to disk after
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6113 writing to it. This takes some time, especially on busy unix systems.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6114 When this option is empty parts of the swap file may be in memory and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6115 not written to disk. When the system crashes you may lose more work.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6116 On Unix the system does a sync now and then without Vim asking for it,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6117 so the disadvantage of setting this option off is small. On some
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6118 systems the swap file will not be written at all. For a unix system
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6119 setting it to "sync" will use the sync() call instead of the default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6120 fsync(), which may work better on some systems.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
6121 The 'fsync' option is used for the actual file.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6122
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6123 *'switchbuf'* *'swb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6124 'switchbuf' 'swb' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6125 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6126 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6127 This option controls the behavior when switching between buffers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6128 Possible values (comma separated list):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6129 useopen If included, jump to the first open window that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6130 contains the specified buffer (if there is one).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6131 Otherwise: Do not examine other windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6132 This setting is checked with |quickfix| commands, when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6133 jumping to errors (":cc", ":cn", "cp", etc.). It is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6134 also used in all buffer related split commands, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6135 example ":sbuffer", ":sbnext", or ":sbrewind".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6136 split If included, split the current window before loading
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6137 a buffer. Otherwise: do not split, use current window.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6138 Supported in |quickfix| commands that display errors.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6139
410
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6140 *'synmaxcol'* *'smc'*
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6141 'synmaxcol' 'smc' number (default 3000)
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6142 local to buffer
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6143 {not in Vi}
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6144 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6145 feature}
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6146 Maximum column in which to search for syntax items. In long lines the
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6147 text after this column is not highlighted and following lines may not
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6148 be highlighted correctly, because the syntax state is cleared.
410
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6149 This helps to avoid very slow redrawing for an XML file that is one
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6150 long line.
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6151 Set to zero to remove the limit.
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6152
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6153 *'syntax'* *'syn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6154 'syntax' 'syn' string (default empty)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6155 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6156 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6157 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6158 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6159 When this option is set, the syntax with this name is loaded, unless
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6160 syntax highlighting has been switched off with ":syntax off".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6161 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current syntax (the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6162 b:current_syntax variable does).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6163 This option is most useful in a modeline, for a file which syntax is
410
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6164 not automatically recognized. Example, in an IDL file: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6165 /* vim: set syntax=idl : */
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6166 < To switch off syntax highlighting for the current file, use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6167 :set syntax=OFF
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6168 < To switch syntax highlighting on according to the current value of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6169 'filetype' option: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6170 :set syntax=ON
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6171 < What actually happens when setting the 'syntax' option is that the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6172 Syntax autocommand event is triggered with the value as argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6173 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6174 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
6175 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6176
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6177 *'tabstop'* *'ts'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6178 'tabstop' 'ts' number (default 8)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6179 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6180 Number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for. Also see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6181 |:retab| command, and 'softtabstop' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6182
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6183 Note: Setting 'tabstop' to any other value than 8 can make your file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6184 appear wrong in many places (e.g., when printing it).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6185
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6186 There are four main ways to use tabs in Vim:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6187 1. Always keep 'tabstop' at 8, set 'softtabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to 4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6188 (or 3 or whatever you prefer) and use 'noexpandtab'. Then Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6189 will use a mix of tabs and spaces, but typing Tab and BS will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6190 behave like a tab appears every 4 (or 3) characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6191 2. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6192 'expandtab'. This way you will always insert spaces. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6193 formatting will never be messed up when 'tabstop' is changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6194 3. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use a
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6195 |modeline| to set these values when editing the file again. Only
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6196 works when using Vim to edit the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6197 4. Always set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to the same value, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6198 'noexpandtab'. This should then work (for initial indents only)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6199 for any tabstop setting that people use. It might be nice to have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6200 tabs after the first non-blank inserted as spaces if you do this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6201 though. Otherwise aligned comments will be wrong when 'tabstop' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6202 changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6203
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6204 *'tagbsearch'* *'tbs'* *'notagbsearch'* *'notbs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6205 'tagbsearch' 'tbs' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6206 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6207 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6208 When searching for a tag (e.g., for the |:ta| command), Vim can either
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6209 use a binary search or a linear search in a tags file. Binary
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6210 searching makes searching for a tag a LOT faster, but a linear search
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6211 will find more tags if the tags file wasn't properly sorted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6212 Vim normally assumes that your tags files are sorted, or indicate that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6213 they are not sorted. Only when this is not the case does the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6214 'tagbsearch' option need to be switched off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6215
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6216 When 'tagbsearch' is on, binary searching is first used in the tags
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6217 files. In certain situations, Vim will do a linear search instead for
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6218 certain files, or retry all files with a linear search. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6219 'tagbsearch' is off, only a linear search is done.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6220
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6221 Linear searching is done anyway, for one file, when Vim finds a line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6222 at the start of the file indicating that it's not sorted: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6223 !_TAG_FILE_SORTED 0 /some command/
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6224 < [The whitespace before and after the '0' must be a single <Tab>]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6225
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6226 When a binary search was done and no match was found in any of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6227 files listed in 'tags', and 'ignorecase' is set or a pattern is used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6228 instead of a normal tag name, a retry is done with a linear search.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6229 Tags in unsorted tags files, and matches with different case will only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6230 be found in the retry.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6231
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 20
diff changeset
6232 If a tag file indicates that it is case-fold sorted, the second,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6233 linear search can be avoided for the 'ignorecase' case. Use a value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6234 of '2' in the "!_TAG_FILE_SORTED" line for this. A tag file can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6235 case-fold sorted with the -f switch to "sort" in most unices, as in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6236 the command: "sort -f -o tags tags". For "Exuberant ctags" version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6237 5.3 or higher the -f or --fold-case-sort switch can be used for this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6238 as well. Note that case must be folded to uppercase for this to work.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6239
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6240 When 'tagbsearch' is off, tags searching is slower when a full match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6241 exists, but faster when no full match exists. Tags in unsorted tags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6242 files may only be found with 'tagbsearch' off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6243 When the tags file is not sorted, or sorted in a wrong way (not on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6244 ASCII byte value), 'tagbsearch' should be off, or the line given above
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6245 must be included in the tags file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6246 This option doesn't affect commands that find all matching tags (e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6247 command-line completion and ":help").
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6248 {Vi: always uses binary search in some versions}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6249
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6250 *'taglength'* *'tl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6251 'taglength' 'tl' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6252 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6253 If non-zero, tags are significant up to this number of characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6254
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6255 *'tagrelative'* *'tr'* *'notagrelative'* *'notr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6256 'tagrelative' 'tr' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6257 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6258 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6259 If on and using a tag file in another directory, file names in that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6260 tag file are relative to the directory where the tag file is.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6261 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6262 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6263
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6264 *'tags'* *'tag'* *E433*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6265 'tags' 'tag' string (default "./tags,tags", when compiled with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6266 |+emacs_tags|: "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6267 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6268 Filenames for the tag command, separated by spaces or commas. To
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6269 include a space or comma in a file name, precede it with a backslash
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6270 (see |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6271 When a file name starts with "./", the '.' is replaced with the path
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6272 of the current file. But only when the 'd' flag is not included in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6273 'cpoptions'. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. Also see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6274 |tags-option|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6275 "*", "**" and other wildcards can be used to search for tags files in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6276 a directory tree. See |file-searching|. {not available when compiled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6277 without the |+path_extra| feature}
515
04dcb5a1f2f9 updated for version 7.0144
vimboss
parents: 502
diff changeset
6278 The |tagfiles()| function can be used to get a list of the file names
04dcb5a1f2f9 updated for version 7.0144
vimboss
parents: 502
diff changeset
6279 actually used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6280 If Vim was compiled with the |+emacs_tags| feature, Emacs-style tag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6281 files are also supported. They are automatically recognized. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6282 default value becomes "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS", unless case
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6283 differences are ignored (MS-Windows). |emacs-tags|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6284 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6285 file names from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6286 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6287 {Vi: default is "tags /usr/lib/tags"}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6288
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6289 *'tagstack'* *'tgst'* *'notagstack'* *'notgst'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6290 'tagstack' 'tgst' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6291 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6292 {not in all versions of Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6293 When on, the |tagstack| is used normally. When off, a ":tag" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6294 ":tselect" command with an argument will not push the tag onto the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6295 tagstack. A following ":tag" without an argument, a ":pop" command or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6296 any other command that uses the tagstack will use the unmodified
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6297 tagstack, but does change the pointer to the active entry.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6298 Resetting this option is useful when using a ":tag" command in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6299 mapping which should not change the tagstack.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6300
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6301 *'term'* *E529* *E530* *E531*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6302 'term' string (default is $TERM, if that fails:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6303 in the GUI: "builtin_gui"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6304 on Amiga: "amiga"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6305 on BeOS: "beos-ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6306 on Mac: "mac-ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6307 on MiNT: "vt52"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6308 on MS-DOS: "pcterm"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6309 on OS/2: "os2ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6310 on Unix: "ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6311 on VMS: "ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6312 on Win 32: "win32")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6313 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6314 Name of the terminal. Used for choosing the terminal control
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6315 characters. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6316 For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6317 :set term=$TERM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6318 < See |termcap|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6319
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6320 *'termbidi'* *'tbidi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6321 *'notermbidi'* *'notbidi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6322 'termbidi' 'tbidi' boolean (default off, on for "mlterm")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6323 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6324 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6325 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6326 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6327 The terminal is in charge of Bi-directionality of text (as specified
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6328 by Unicode). The terminal is also expected to do the required shaping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6329 that some languages (such as Arabic) require.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6330 Setting this option implies that 'rightleft' will not be set when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6331 'arabic' is set and the value of 'arabicshape' will be ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6332 Note that setting 'termbidi' has the immediate effect that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6333 'arabicshape' is ignored, but 'rightleft' isn't changed automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6334 This option is reset when the GUI is started.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6335 For further details see |arabic.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6336
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6337 *'termencoding'* *'tenc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6338 'termencoding' 'tenc' string (default ""; with GTK+ 2 GUI: "utf-8"; with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6339 Macintosh GUI: "macroman")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6340 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6341 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6342 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6343 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6344 Encoding used for the terminal. This specifies what character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6345 encoding the keyboard produces and the display will understand. For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6346 the GUI it only applies to the keyboard ('encoding' is used for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6347 display).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6348 In the Win32 console version the default value is the console codepage
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6349 when it differs from the ANSI codepage.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6350 *E617*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6351 Note: This does not apply to the GTK+ 2 GUI. After the GUI has been
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6352 successfully initialized, 'termencoding' is forcibly set to "utf-8".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6353 Any attempts to set a different value will be rejected, and an error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6354 message is shown.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6355 For the Win32 GUI 'termencoding' is not used for typed characters,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6356 because the Win32 system always passes Unicode characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6357 When empty, the same encoding is used as for the 'encoding' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6358 This is the normal value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6359 Not all combinations for 'termencoding' and 'encoding' are valid. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6360 |encoding-table|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6361 The value for this option must be supported by internal conversions or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6362 iconv(). When this is not possible no conversion will be done and you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6363 will probably experience problems with non-ASCII characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6364 Example: You are working with the locale set to euc-jp (Japanese) and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6365 want to edit a UTF-8 file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6366 :let &termencoding = &encoding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6367 :set encoding=utf-8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6368 < You need to do this when your system has no locale support for UTF-8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6369
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6370 *'terse'* *'noterse'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6371 'terse' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6372 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6373 When set: Add 's' flag to 'shortmess' option (this makes the message
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6374 for a search that hits the start or end of the file not being
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6375 displayed). When reset: Remove 's' flag from 'shortmess' option. {Vi
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6376 shortens a lot of messages}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6377
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6378 *'textauto'* *'ta'* *'notextauto'* *'nota'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6379 'textauto' 'ta' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6380 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6381 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6382 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformats'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6383 For backwards compatibility, when 'textauto' is set, 'fileformats' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6384 set to the default value for the current system. When 'textauto' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6385 reset, 'fileformats' is made empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6386 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6387 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6388
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6389 *'textmode'* *'tx'* *'notextmode'* *'notx'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6390 'textmode' 'tx' boolean (MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2: default on,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6391 others: default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6392 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6393 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6394 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformat'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6395 For backwards compatibility, when 'textmode' is set, 'fileformat' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6396 set to "dos". When 'textmode' is reset, 'fileformat' is set to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6397 "unix".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6398
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6399 *'textwidth'* *'tw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6400 'textwidth' 'tw' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6401 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6402 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6403 Maximum width of text that is being inserted. A longer line will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6404 broken after white space to get this width. A zero value disables
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6405 this. 'textwidth' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set. When
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6406 'textwidth' is zero, 'wrapmargin' may be used. See also
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6407 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6408 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6409
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6410 *'thesaurus'* *'tsr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6411 'thesaurus' 'tsr' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6412 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6413 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6414 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6415 for thesaurus completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|. Each line in
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6416 the file should contain words with similar meaning, separated by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6417 non-keyword characters (white space is preferred). Maximum line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6418 length is 510 bytes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6419 To obtain a file to be used here, check out the wordlist FAQ at
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6420 http://www.hyphenologist.co.uk .
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6421 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6422 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6423 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6424 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6425 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6426 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6427 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6428
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6429 *'tildeop'* *'top'* *'notildeop'* *'notop'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6430 'tildeop' 'top' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6431 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6432 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6433 When on: The tilde command "~" behaves like an operator.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6434 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6435
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6436 *'timeout'* *'to'* *'notimeout'* *'noto'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6437 'timeout' 'to' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6438 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6439 *'ttimeout'* *'nottimeout'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6440 'ttimeout' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6441 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6442 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6443 These two options together determine the behavior when part of a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6444 mapped key sequence or keyboard code has been received:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6445
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6446 'timeout' 'ttimeout' action ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6447 off off do not time out
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6448 on on or off time out on :mappings and key codes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6449 off on time out on key codes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6450
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6451 If both options are off, Vim will wait until either the complete
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6452 mapping or key sequence has been received, or it is clear that there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6453 is no mapping or key sequence for the received characters. For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6454 example: if you have mapped "vl" and Vim has received 'v', the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6455 character is needed to see if the 'v' is followed by an 'l'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6456 When one of the options is on, Vim will wait for about 1 second for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6457 the next character to arrive. After that the already received
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6458 characters are interpreted as single characters. The waiting time can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6459 be changed with the 'timeoutlen' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6460 On slow terminals or very busy systems timing out may cause
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6461 malfunctioning cursor keys. If both options are off, Vim waits
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6462 forever after an entered <Esc> if there are key codes that start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6463 with <Esc>. You will have to type <Esc> twice. If you do not have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6464 problems with key codes, but would like to have :mapped key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6465 sequences not timing out in 1 second, set the 'ttimeout' option and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6466 reset the 'timeout' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6467
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6468 NOTE: 'ttimeout' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6469
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6470 *'timeoutlen'* *'tm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6471 'timeoutlen' 'tm' number (default 1000)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6472 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6473 {not in all versions of Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6474 *'ttimeoutlen'* *'ttm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6475 'ttimeoutlen' 'ttm' number (default -1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6476 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6477 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6478 The time in milliseconds that is waited for a key code or mapped key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6479 sequence to complete. Also used for CTRL-\ CTRL-N and CTRL-\ CTRL-G
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6480 when part of a command has been typed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6481 Normally only 'timeoutlen' is used and 'ttimeoutlen' is -1. When a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6482 different timeout value for key codes is desired set 'ttimeoutlen' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6483 a non-negative number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6484
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6485 ttimeoutlen mapping delay key code delay ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6486 < 0 'timeoutlen' 'timeoutlen'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6487 >= 0 'timeoutlen' 'ttimeoutlen'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6488
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6489 The timeout only happens when the 'timeout' and 'ttimeout' options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6490 tell so. A useful setting would be >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6491 :set timeout timeoutlen=3000 ttimeoutlen=100
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6492 < (time out on mapping after three seconds, time out on key codes after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6493 a tenth of a second).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6494
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6495 *'title'* *'notitle'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6496 'title' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6497 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6498 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6499 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6500 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6501 When on, the title of the window will be set to the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6502 'titlestring' (if it is not empty), or to:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6503 filename [+=-] (path) - VIM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6504 Where:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6505 filename the name of the file being edited
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6506 - indicates the file cannot be modified, 'ma' off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6507 + indicates the file was modified
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6508 = indicates the file is read-only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6509 =+ indicates the file is read-only and modified
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6510 (path) is the path of the file being edited
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6511 - VIM the server name |v:servername| or "VIM"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6512 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6513 (currently Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6514 terminals with a non- empty 't_ts' option - these are Unix xterm and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6515 iris-ansi by default, where 't_ts' is taken from the builtin termcap).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6516 *X11*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6517 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6518 be restored if possible. The output of ":version" will include "+X11"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6519 when HAVE_X11 was defined, otherwise it will be "-X11". This also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6520 works for the icon name |'icon'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6521 But: When Vim was started with the |-X| argument, restoring the title
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6522 will not work (except in the GUI).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6523 If the title cannot be restored, it is set to the value of 'titleold'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6524 You might want to restore the title outside of Vim then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6525 When using an xterm from a remote machine you can use this command:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6526 rsh machine_name xterm -display $DISPLAY &
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6527 then the WINDOWID environment variable should be inherited and the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6528 title of the window should change back to what it should be after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6529 exiting Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6530
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6531 *'titlelen'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6532 'titlelen' number (default 85)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6533 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6534 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6535 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6536 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6537 Gives the percentage of 'columns' to use for the length of the window
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6538 title. When the title is longer, only the end of the path name is
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6539 shown. A '<' character before the path name is used to indicate this.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6540 Using a percentage makes this adapt to the width of the window. But
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6541 it won't work perfectly, because the actual number of characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6542 available also depends on the font used and other things in the title
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6543 bar. When 'titlelen' is zero the full path is used. Otherwise,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6544 values from 1 to 30000 percent can be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6545 'titlelen' is also used for the 'titlestring' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6546
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6547 *'titleold'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6548 'titleold' string (default "Thanks for flying Vim")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6549 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6550 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6551 {only available when compiled with the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6552 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6553 This option will be used for the window title when exiting Vim if the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6554 original title cannot be restored. Only happens if 'title' is on or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6555 'titlestring' is not empty.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
6556 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
6557 security reasons.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6558 *'titlestring'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6559 'titlestring' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6560 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6561 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6562 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6563 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6564 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the title of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6565 window. This happens only when the 'title' option is on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6566 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles (currently
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6567 Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and terminals with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6568 non-empty 't_ts' option).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6569 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6570 be restored if possible |X11|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6571 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6572 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6573 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6574 :auto BufEnter * let &titlestring = hostname() . "/" . expand("%:p")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6575 :set title titlestring=%<%F%=%l/%L-%P titlelen=70
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6576 < The value of 'titlelen' is used to align items in the middle or right
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6577 of the available space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6578 Some people prefer to have the file name first: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6579 :set titlestring=%t%(\ %M%)%(\ (%{expand(\"%:~:.:h\")})%)%(\ %a%)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6580 < Note the use of "%{ }" and an expression to get the path of the file,
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6581 without the file name. The "%( %)" constructs are used to add a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6582 separating space only when needed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6583 NOTE: Use of special characters in 'titlestring' may cause the display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6584 to be garbled (e.g., when it contains a CR or NL character).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6585 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6586
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6587 *'toolbar'* *'tb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6588 'toolbar' 'tb' string (default "icons,tooltips")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6589 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6590 {only for |+GUI_GTK|, |+GUI_Athena|, |+GUI_Motif| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6591 |+GUI_Photon|}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6592 The contents of this option controls various toolbar settings. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6593 possible values are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6594 icons Toolbar buttons are shown with icons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6595 text Toolbar buttons shown with text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6596 horiz Icon and text of a toolbar button are
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6597 horizontally arranged. {only in GTK+ 2 GUI}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6598 tooltips Tooltips are active for toolbar buttons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6599 Tooltips refer to the popup help text which appears after the mouse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6600 cursor is placed over a toolbar button for a brief moment.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6601
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6602 If you want the toolbar to be shown with icons as well as text, do the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6603 following: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6604 :set tb=icons,text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6605 < Motif and Athena cannot display icons and text at the same time. They
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6606 will show icons if both are requested.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6607
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6608 If none of the strings specified in 'toolbar' are valid or if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6609 'toolbar' is empty, this option is ignored. If you want to disable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6610 the toolbar, you need to set the 'guioptions' option. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6611 :set guioptions-=T
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6612 < Also see |gui-toolbar|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6613
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6614 *'toolbariconsize'* *'tbis'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6615 'toolbariconsize' 'tbis' string (default "small")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6616 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6617 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6618 {only in the GTK+ 2 GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6619 Controls the size of toolbar icons. The possible values are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6620 tiny Use tiny toolbar icons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6621 small Use small toolbar icons (default).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6622 medium Use medium-sized toolbar icons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6623 large Use large toolbar icons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6624 The exact dimensions in pixels of the various icon sizes depend on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6625 the current theme. Common dimensions are large=32x32, medium=24x24,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6626 small=20x20 and tiny=16x16.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6627
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6628 If 'toolbariconsize' is empty, the global default size as determined
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6629 by user preferences or the current theme is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6630
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6631 *'ttybuiltin'* *'tbi'* *'nottybuiltin'* *'notbi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6632 'ttybuiltin' 'tbi' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6633 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6634 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6635 When on, the builtin termcaps are searched before the external ones.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6636 When off the builtin termcaps are searched after the external ones.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6637 When this option is changed, you should set the 'term' option next for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6638 the change to take effect, for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6639 :set notbi term=$TERM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6640 < See also |termcap|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6641 Rationale: The default for this option is "on", because the builtin
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6642 termcap entries are generally better (many systems contain faulty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6643 xterm entries...).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6644
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6645 *'ttyfast'* *'tf'* *'nottyfast'* *'notf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6646 'ttyfast' 'tf' boolean (default off, on when 'term' is xterm, hpterm,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6647 sun-cmd, screen, rxvt, dtterm or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6648 iris-ansi; also on when running Vim in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6649 a DOS console)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6650 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6651 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6652 Indicates a fast terminal connection. More characters will be sent to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6653 the screen for redrawing, instead of using insert/delete line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6654 commands. Improves smoothness of redrawing when there are multiple
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6655 windows and the terminal does not support a scrolling region.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6656 Also enables the extra writing of characters at the end of each screen
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6657 line for lines that wrap. This helps when using copy/paste with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6658 mouse in an xterm and other terminals.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6659
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6660 *'ttymouse'* *'ttym'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6661 'ttymouse' 'ttym' string (default depends on 'term')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6662 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6663 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6664 {only in Unix and VMS, doesn't work in the GUI; not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6665 available when compiled without |+mouse|}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6666 Name of the terminal type for which mouse codes are to be recognized.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6667 Currently these three strings are valid:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6668 *xterm-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6669 xterm xterm-like mouse handling. The mouse generates
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6670 "<Esc>[Mscr", where "scr" is three bytes:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6671 "s" = button state
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6672 "c" = column plus 33
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6673 "r" = row plus 33
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
6674 This only works up to 223 columns! See "dec" for a
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
6675 solution.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6676 xterm2 Works like "xterm", but with the xterm reporting the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6677 mouse position while the mouse is dragged. This works
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6678 much faster and more precise. Your xterm must at
180
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
6679 least at patchlevel 88 / XFree 3.3.3 for this to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6680 work. See below for how Vim detects this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6681 automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6682 *netterm-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6683 netterm NetTerm mouse handling. The mouse generates
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6684 "<Esc>}r,c<CR>", where "r,c" are two decimal numbers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6685 for the row and column.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6686 *dec-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6687 dec DEC terminal mouse handling. The mouse generates a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6688 rather complex sequence, starting with "<Esc>[".
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
6689 This is also available for an Xterm, if it was
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
6690 configured with "--enable-dec-locator".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6691 *jsbterm-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6692 jsbterm JSB term mouse handling.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6693 *pterm-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6694 pterm QNX pterm mouse handling.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6695
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6696 The mouse handling must be enabled at compile time |+mouse_xterm|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6697 |+mouse_dec| |+mouse_netterm|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6698 Only "xterm"(2) is really recognized. NetTerm mouse codes are always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6699 recognized, if enabled at compile time. DEC terminal mouse codes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6700 are recognized if enabled at compile time, and 'ttymouse' is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6701 "xterm" (because the xterm and dec mouse codes conflict).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6702 This option is automatically set to "xterm", when the 'term' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6703 set to a name that starts with "xterm", and 'ttymouse' is not "xterm"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6704 or "xterm2" already. The main use of this option is to set it to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6705 "xterm", when the terminal name doesn't start with "xterm", but it can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6706 handle xterm mouse codes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6707 The "xterm2" value will be set if the xterm version is reported to be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6708 95 of higher. This only works when compiled with the |+termresponse|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6709 feature and if |t_RV| is set to the escape sequence to request the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6710 xterm version number. Otherwise "xterm2" must be set explicitly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6711 If you do not want 'ttymouse' to be set to "xterm2" automatically, set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6712 t_RV to an empty string: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6713 :set t_RV=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6714 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6715 *'ttyscroll'* *'tsl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6716 'ttyscroll' 'tsl' number (default 999)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6717 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6718 Maximum number of lines to scroll the screen. If there are more lines
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6719 to scroll the window is redrawn. For terminals where scrolling is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6720 very slow and redrawing is not slow this can be set to a small number,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6721 e.g., 3, to speed up displaying.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6722
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6723 *'ttytype'* *'tty'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6724 'ttytype' 'tty' string (default from $TERM)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6725 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6726 Alias for 'term', see above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6727
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6728 *'undolevels'* *'ul'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6729 'undolevels' 'ul' number (default 100, 1000 for Unix, VMS,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6730 Win32 and OS/2)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6731 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6732 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6733 Maximum number of changes that can be undone. Since undo information
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6734 is kept in memory, higher numbers will cause more memory to be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6735 (nevertheless, a single change can use an unlimited amount of memory).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6736 Set to 0 for Vi compatibility: One level of undo and "u" undoes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6737 itself: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6738 set ul=0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6739 < But you can also get Vi compatibility by including the 'u' flag in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6740 'cpoptions', and still be able to use CTRL-R to repeat undo.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6741 Set to a negative number for no undo at all: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6742 set ul=-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6743 < This helps when you run out of memory for a single change.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6744 Also see |undo-two-ways|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6745
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6746 *'updatecount'* *'uc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6747 'updatecount' 'uc' number (default: 200)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6748 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6749 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6750 After typing this many characters the swap file will be written to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6751 disk. When zero, no swap file will be created at all (see chapter on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6752 recovery |crash-recovery|). 'updatecount' is set to zero by starting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6753 Vim with the "-n" option, see |startup|. When editing in readonly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6754 mode this option will be initialized to 10000.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6755 The swapfile can be disabled per buffer with |'swapfile'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6756 When 'updatecount' is set from zero to non-zero, swap files are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6757 created for all buffers that have 'swapfile' set. When 'updatecount'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6758 is set to zero, existing swap files are not deleted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6759 Also see |'swapsync'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6760 This option has no meaning in buffers where |'buftype'| is "nofile"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6761 or "nowrite".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6762
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6763 *'updatetime'* *'ut'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6764 'updatetime' 'ut' number (default 4000)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6765 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6766 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6767 If this many milliseconds nothing is typed the swap file will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6768 written to disk (see |crash-recovery|). Also used for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6769 |CursorHold| autocommand event.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6770
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6771 *'verbose'* *'vbs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6772 'verbose' 'vbs' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6773 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6774 {not in Vi, although some versions have a boolean
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6775 verbose option}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6776 When bigger than zero, Vim will give messages about what it is doing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6777 Currently, these messages are given:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6778 >= 1 When the viminfo file is read or written.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6779 >= 2 When a file is ":source"'ed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6780 >= 5 Every searched tags file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6781 >= 8 Files for which a group of autocommands is executed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6782 >= 9 Every executed autocommand.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6783 >= 12 Every executed function.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6784 >= 13 When an exception is thrown, caught, finished, or discarded.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6785 >= 14 Anything pending in a ":finally" clause.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6786 >= 15 Every executed Ex command (truncated at 200 characters).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6787
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6788 This option can also be set with the "-V" argument. See |-V|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6789 This option is also set by the |:verbose| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6790
293
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
6791 When the 'verbosefile' option is set then the verbose messages are not
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
6792 displayed.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
6793
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
6794 *'verbosefile'* *'vfile'*
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
6795 'verbosefile' 'vfile' string (default empty)
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
6796 global
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
6797 {not in Vi}
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
6798 When not empty all messages are written in a file with this name.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
6799 When the file exists messages are appended.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
6800 Writing to the file ends when Vim exits or when 'verbosefile' is made
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
6801 empty.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
6802 Setting 'verbosefile' to a new value is like making it empty first.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
6803 The difference with |:redir| is that verbose messages are not
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
6804 displayed when 'verbosefile' is set.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
6805
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6806 *'viewdir'* *'vdir'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6807 'viewdir' 'vdir' string (default for Amiga, MS-DOS, OS/2 and Win32:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6808 "$VIM/vimfiles/view",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6809 for Unix: "~/.vim/view",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6810 for Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles:view"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6811 for VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles/view"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6812 for RiscOS: "Choices:vimfiles/view")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6813 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6814 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6815 {not available when compiled without the +mksession
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6816 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6817 Name of the directory where to store files for |:mkview|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6818 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6819 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6820
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6821 *'viewoptions'* *'vop'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6822 'viewoptions' 'vop' string (default: "folds,options,cursor")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6823 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6824 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6825 {not available when compiled without the +mksession
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6826 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6827 Changes the effect of the |:mkview| command. It is a comma separated
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6828 list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring something:
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6829 word save and restore ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6830 cursor cursor position in file and in window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6831 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6832 fold options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6833 options options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6834 global values for local options)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6835 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6836 slashes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6837 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6838 on Windows or DOS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6839
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6840 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing view files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6841 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6842 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6843
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6844 *'viminfo'* *'vi'* *E526* *E527* *E528*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6845 'viminfo' 'vi' string (Vi default: "", Vim default for MS-DOS,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6846 Windows and OS/2: '20,<50,s10,h,rA:,rB:,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6847 for Amiga: '20,<50,s10,h,rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6848 for others: '20,<50,s10,h)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6849 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6850 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6851 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6852 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6853 When non-empty, the viminfo file is read upon startup and written
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6854 when exiting Vim (see |viminfo-file|). The string should be a comma
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6855 separated list of parameters, each consisting of a single character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6856 identifying the particular parameter, followed by a number or string
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6857 which specifies the value of that parameter. If a particular
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6858 character is left out, then the default value is used for that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6859 parameter. The following is a list of the identifying characters and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6860 the effect of their value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6861 CHAR VALUE ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6862 ! When included, save and restore global variables that start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6863 with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6864 letter. Thus "KEEPTHIS and "K_L_M" are stored, but "KeepThis"
75
388f285bda1b updated for version 7.0031
vimboss
parents: 41
diff changeset
6865 and "_K_L_M" are not. Only String and Number types are
388f285bda1b updated for version 7.0031
vimboss
parents: 41
diff changeset
6866 stored.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6867 " Maximum number of lines saved for each register. Old name of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6868 the '<' item, with the disadvantage that you need to put a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6869 backslash before the ", otherwise it will be recognized as the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6870 start of a comment!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6871 % When included, save and restore the buffer list. If Vim is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6872 started with a file name argument, the buffer list is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6873 restored. If Vim is started without a file name argument, the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6874 buffer list is restored from the viminfo file. Buffers
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6875 without a file name and buffers for help files are not written
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6876 to the viminfo file.
23
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
6877 When followed by a number, the number specifies the maximum
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
6878 number of buffers that are stored. Without a number all
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
6879 buffers are stored.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6880 ' Maximum number of previously edited files for which the marks
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6881 are remembered. This parameter must always be included when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6882 'viminfo' is non-empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6883 Including this item also means that the |jumplist| and the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6884 |changelist| are stored in the viminfo file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6885 / Maximum number of items in the search pattern history to be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6886 saved. If non-zero, then the previous search and substitute
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6887 patterns are also saved. When not included, the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6888 'history' is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6889 : Maximum number of items in the command-line history to be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6890 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6891 < Maximum number of lines saved for each register. If zero then
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6892 registers are not saved. When not included, all lines are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6893 saved. '"' is the old name for this item.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6894 Also see the 's' item below: limit specified in Kbyte.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6895 @ Maximum number of items in the input-line history to be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6896 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6897 c When included, convert the text in the viminfo file from the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6898 'encoding' used when writing the file to the current
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6899 'encoding'. See |viminfo-encoding|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6900 f Whether file marks need to be stored. If zero, file marks ('0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6901 to '9, 'A to 'Z) are not stored. When not present or when
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6902 non-zero, they are all stored. '0 is used for the current
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6903 cursor position (when exiting or when doing ":wviminfo").
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6904 h Disable the effect of 'hlsearch' when loading the viminfo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6905 file. When not included, it depends on whether ":nohlsearch"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6906 has been used since the last search command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6907 n Name of the viminfo file. The name must immediately follow
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6908 the 'n'. Must be the last one! If the "-i" argument was
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6909 given when starting Vim, that file name overrides the one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6910 given here with 'viminfo'. Environment variables are expanded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6911 when opening the file, not when setting the option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6912 r Removable media. The argument is a string (up to the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6913 ','). This parameter can be given several times. Each
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6914 specifies the start of a path for which no marks will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6915 stored. This is to avoid removable media. For MS-DOS you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6916 could use "ra:,rb:", for Amiga "rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:". You can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6917 also use it for temp files, e.g., for Unix: "r/tmp". Case is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6918 ignored. Maximum length of each 'r' argument is 50
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6919 characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6920 s Maximum size of an item in Kbyte. If zero then registers are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6921 not saved. Currently only applies to registers. The default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6922 "s10" will exclude registers with more than 10 Kbyte of text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6923 Also see the '<' item above: line count limit.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6924
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6925 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6926 :set viminfo='50,<1000,s100,:0,n~/vim/viminfo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6927 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6928 '50 Marks will be remembered for the last 50 files you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6929 edited.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6930 <1000 Contents of registers (up to 1000 lines each) will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6931 remembered.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6932 s100 Registers with more than 100 Kbyte text are skipped.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6933 :0 Command-line history will not be saved.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6934 n~/vim/viminfo The name of the file to use is "~/vim/viminfo".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6935 no / Since '/' is not specified, the default will be used,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6936 that is, save all of the search history, and also the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6937 previous search and substitute patterns.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6938 no % The buffer list will not be saved nor read back.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6939 no h 'hlsearch' highlighting will be restored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6940
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6941 When setting 'viminfo' from an empty value you can use |:rviminfo| to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6942 load the contents of the file, this is not done automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6943
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6944 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6945 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6946
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6947 *'virtualedit'* *'ve'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6948 'virtualedit' 've' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6949 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6950 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6951 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6952 |+virtualedit| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6953 A comma separated list of these words:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6954 block Allow virtual editing in Visual block mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6955 insert Allow virtual editing in Insert mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6956 all Allow virtual editing in all modes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6957 Virtual editing means that the cursor can be positioned where there is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6958 no actual character. This can be halfway into a Tab or beyond the end
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6959 of the line. Useful for selecting a rectangle in Visual mode and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6960 editing a table.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6961
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6962 *'visualbell'* *'vb'* *'novisualbell'* *'novb'* *beep*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6963 'visualbell' 'vb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6964 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6965 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6966 Use visual bell instead of beeping. The terminal code to display the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6967 visual bell is given with 't_vb'. When no beep or flash is wanted,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6968 use ":set vb t_vb=".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6969 Note: When the GUI starts, 't_vb' is reset to its default value. You
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6970 might want to set it again in your |gvimrc|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6971 In the GUI, 't_vb' defaults to "<Esc>|f", which inverts the display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6972 for 20 msec. If you want to use a different time, use "<Esc>|40f",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6973 where 40 is the time in msec.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6974 Does not work on the Amiga, you always get a screen flash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6975 Also see 'errorbells'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6976
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6977 *'warn'* *'nowarn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6978 'warn' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6979 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6980 Give a warning message when a shell command is used while the buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6981 has been changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6982
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6983 *'weirdinvert'* *'wiv'* *'noweirdinvert'* *'nowiv'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6984 'weirdinvert' 'wiv' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6985 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6986 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6987 This option has the same effect as the 't_xs' termcap option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6988 It is provided for backwards compatibility with version 4.x.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6989 Setting 'weirdinvert' has the effect of making 't_xs' non-empty, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6990 vice versa. Has no effect when the GUI is running.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6991
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6992 *'whichwrap'* *'ww'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6993 'whichwrap' 'ww' string (Vim default: "b,s", Vi default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6994 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6995 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6996 Allow specified keys that move the cursor left/right to move to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6997 previous/next line when the cursor is on the first/last character in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6998 the line. Concatenate characters to allow this for these keys:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6999 char key mode ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7000 b <BS> Normal and Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7001 s <Space> Normal and Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7002 h "h" Normal and Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7003 l "l" Normal and Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7004 < <Left> Normal and Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7005 > <Right> Normal and Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7006 ~ "~" Normal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7007 [ <Left> Insert and Replace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7008 ] <Right> Insert and Replace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7009 For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7010 :set ww=<,>,[,]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7011 < allows wrap only when cursor keys are used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7012 When the movement keys are used in combination with a delete or change
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7013 operator, the <EOL> also counts for a character. This makes "3h"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7014 different from "3dh" when the cursor crosses the end of a line. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7015 is also true for "x" and "X", because they do the same as "dl" and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7016 "dh". If you use this, you may also want to use the mapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7017 ":map <BS> X" to make backspace delete the character in front of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7018 cursor.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7019 When 'l' is included, you get a side effect: "yl" on an empty line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7020 will include the <EOL>, so that "p" will insert a new line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7021 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7022 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7023
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7024 *'wildchar'* *'wc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7025 'wildchar' 'wc' number (Vim default: <Tab>, Vi default: CTRL-E)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7026 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7027 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7028 Character you have to type to start wildcard expansion in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7029 command-line, as specified with 'wildmode'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7030 The character is not recognized when used inside a macro. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7031 'wildcharm' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7032 Although 'wc' is a number option, you can set it to a special key: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7033 :set wc=<Esc>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7034 < NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7035 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7036
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7037 *'wildcharm'* *'wcm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7038 'wildcharm' 'wcm' number (default: none (0))
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7039 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7040 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7041 'wildcharm' works exactly like 'wildchar', except that it is
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
7042 recognized when used inside a macro. You can find "spare" command-line
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
7043 keys suitable for this option by looking at |ex-edit-index|. Normally
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7044 you'll never actually type 'wildcharm', just use it in mappings that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7045 automatically invoke completion mode, e.g.: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7046 :set wcm=<C-Z>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7047 :cmap ss so $vim/sessions/*.vim<C-Z>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7048 < Then after typing :ss you can use CTRL-P & CTRL-N.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7049
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7050 *'wildignore'* *'wig'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7051 'wildignore' 'wig' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7052 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7053 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7054 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7055 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7056 A list of file patterns. A file that matches with one of these
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7057 patterns is ignored when completing file or directory names.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7058 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7059 Also see 'suffixes'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7060 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7061 :set wildignore=*.o,*.obj
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7062 < The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7063 a pattern from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7064 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7065
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7066 *'wildmenu'* *'wmnu'* *'nowildmenu'* *'nowmnu'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7067 'wildmenu' 'wmnu' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7068 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7069 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7070 {not available if compiled without the |+wildmenu|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7071 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7072 When 'wildmenu' is on, command-line completion operates in an enhanced
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7073 mode. On pressing 'wildchar' (usually <Tab>) to invoke completion,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7074 the possible matches are shown just above the command line, with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7075 first match highlighted (overwriting the status line, if there is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7076 one). Keys that show the previous/next match, such as <Tab> or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7077 CTRL-P/CTRL-N, cause the highlight to move to the appropriate match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7078 When 'wildmode' is used, "wildmenu" mode is used where "full" is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7079 specified. "longest" and "list" do not start "wildmenu" mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7080 If there are more matches than can fit in the line, a ">" is shown on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7081 the right and/or a "<" is shown on the left. The status line scrolls
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7082 as needed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7083 The "wildmenu" mode is abandoned when a key is hit that is not used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7084 for selecting a completion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7085 While the "wildmenu" is active the following keys have special
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7086 meanings:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7087
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7088 <Left> <Right> - select previous/next match (like CTRL-P/CTRL-N)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7089 <Down> - in filename/menu name completion: move into a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7090 subdirectory or submenu.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7091 <CR> - in menu completion, when the cursor is just after a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7092 dot: move into a submenu.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7093 <Up> - in filename/menu name completion: move up into
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7094 parent directory or parent menu.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7095
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7096 This makes the menus accessible from the console |console-menus|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7097
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7098 If you prefer the <Left> and <Right> keys to move the cursor instead
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7099 of selecting a different match, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7100 :cnoremap <Left> <Space><BS><Left>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7101 :cnoremap <Right> <Space><BS><Right>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7102 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7103 The "WildMenu" highlighting is used for displaying the current match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7104 |hl-WildMenu|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7105
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7106 *'wildmode'* *'wim'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7107 'wildmode' 'wim' string (Vim default: "full")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7108 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7109 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7110 Completion mode that is used for the character specified with
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7111 'wildchar'. It is a comma separated list of up to four parts. Each
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7112 part specifies what to do for each consecutive use of 'wildchar. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7113 first part specifies the behavior for the first use of 'wildchar',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7114 The second part for the second use, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7115 These are the possible values for each part:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7116 "" Complete only the first match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7117 "full" Complete the next full match. After the last match,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7118 the original string is used and then the first match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7119 again.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7120 "longest" Complete till longest common string. If this doesn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7121 result in a longer string, use the next part.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7122 "longest:full" Like "longest", but also start 'wildmenu' if it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7123 enabled.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7124 "list" When more than one match, list all matches.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7125 "list:full" When more than one match, list all matches and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7126 complete first match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7127 "list:longest" When more than one match, list all matches and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7128 complete till longest common string.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7129 When there is only a single match, it is fully completed in all cases.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7130
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7131 Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7132 :set wildmode=full
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
7133 < Complete first full match, next match, etc. (the default) >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7134 :set wildmode=longest,full
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7135 < Complete longest common string, then each full match >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7136 :set wildmode=list:full
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7137 < List all matches and complete each full match >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7138 :set wildmode=list,full
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7139 < List all matches without completing, then each full match >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7140 :set wildmode=longest,list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7141 < Complete longest common string, then list alternatives.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7142
40
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7143 *'wildoptions'* *'wop'*
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7144 'wildoptions' 'wop' string (default "")
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7145 global
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7146 {not in Vi}
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7147 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7148 feature}
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7149 A list of words that change how command line completion is done.
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7150 Currently only one word is allowed:
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7151 tagfile When using CTRL-D to list matching tags, the kind of
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7152 tag and the file of the tag is listed. Only one match
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7153 is displayed per line. Often used tag kinds are:
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7154 d #define
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7155 f function
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7156 Also see |cmdline-completion|.
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7157
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7158 *'winaltkeys'* *'wak'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7159 'winaltkeys' 'wak' string (default "menu")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7160 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7161 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7162 {only used in Win32, Motif, GTK and Photon GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7163 Some GUI versions allow the access to menu entries by using the ALT
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7164 key in combination with a character that appears underlined in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7165 menu. This conflicts with the use of the ALT key for mappings and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7166 entering special characters. This option tells what to do:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7167 no Don't use ALT keys for menus. ALT key combinations can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7168 mapped, but there is no automatic handling. This can then be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7169 done with the |:simalt| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7170 yes ALT key handling is done by the windowing system. ALT key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7171 combinations cannot be mapped.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7172 menu Using ALT in combination with a character that is a menu
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7173 shortcut key, will be handled by the windowing system. Other
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7174 keys can be mapped.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7175 If the menu is disabled by excluding 'm' from 'guioptions', the ALT
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7176 key is never used for the menu.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
7177 This option is not used for <F10>; on Win32 and with GTK <F10> will
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
7178 select the menu, unless it has been mapped.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7179
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7180 *'window'* *'wi'*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7181 'window' 'wi' number (default screen height - 1)
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7182 global
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7183 Window height. Do not confuse this with the height of the Vim window,
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7184 use 'lines' for that.
179
7fd70926e2e1 updated for version 7.0055
vimboss
parents: 170
diff changeset
7185 Used for |CTRL-F| and |CTRL-B| when there is only one window and the
7fd70926e2e1 updated for version 7.0055
vimboss
parents: 170
diff changeset
7186 value is smaller than 'lines' minus one. The screen will scroll
7fd70926e2e1 updated for version 7.0055
vimboss
parents: 170
diff changeset
7187 'window' minus two lines, with a minimum of one.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7188 When 'window' is equal to 'lines' minus one CTRL-F and CTRL-B scroll
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7189 in a much smarter way, taking care of wrapping lines.
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7190 When resizing the Vim window, the value is smaller than 1 or more than
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7191 or equal to 'lines' it will be set to 'lines' minus 1.
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7192 {Vi also uses the option to specify the number of displayed lines}
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7193
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7194 *'winheight'* *'wh'* *E591*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7195 'winheight' 'wh' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7196 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7197 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7198 {not available when compiled without the +windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7199 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7200 Minimal number of lines for the current window. This is not a hard
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7201 minimum, Vim will use fewer lines if there is not enough room. If the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7202 current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7203 height of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7204 always fill the screen (although this has the drawback that ":all"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7205 will create only two windows). Set it to a small number for normal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7206 editing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7207 Minimum value is 1.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7208 The height is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7209 height of the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7210 'winheight' applies to the current window. Use 'winminheight' to set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7211 the minimal height for other windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7212
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7213 *'winfixheight'* *'wfh'* *'nowinfixheight'* *'nowfh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7214 'winfixheight' 'wfh' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7215 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7216 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7217 {not available when compiled without the +windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7218 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7219 Keep the window height when windows are opened or closed and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7220 'equalalways' is set. Set by default for the |preview-window| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7221 |quickfix-window|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7222 The height may be changed anyway when running out of room.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7223
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7224 *'winminheight'* *'wmh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7225 'winminheight' 'wmh' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7226 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7227 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7228 {not available when compiled without the +windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7229 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7230 The minimal height of a window, when it's not the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7231 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7232 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero lines (i.e. just a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7233 status bar) if necessary. They will return to at least one line when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7234 they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere to go.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7235 Use 'winheight' to set the minimal height of the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7236 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7237 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7238 windows. A value of 0 to 3 is reasonable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7239
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7240 *'winminwidth'* *'wmw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7241 'winminwidth' 'wmw' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7242 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7243 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7244 {not available when compiled without the +vertsplit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7245 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7246 The minimal width of a window, when it's not the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7247 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7248 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero columns (i.e. just
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7249 a vertical separator) if necessary. They will return to at least one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7250 line when they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7251 to go.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7252 Use 'winwidth' to set the minimal width of the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7253 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7254 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7255 windows. A value of 0 to 12 is reasonable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7256
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7257 *'winwidth'* *'wiw'* *E592*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7258 'winwidth' 'wiw' number (default 20)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7259 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7260 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7261 {not available when compiled without the +vertsplit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7262 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7263 Minimal number of columns for the current window. This is not a hard
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7264 minimum, Vim will use fewer columns if there is not enough room. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7265 the current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7266 the width of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7267 always fill the screen. Set it to a small number for normal editing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7268 The width is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7269 width of the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7270 'winwidth' applies to the current window. Use 'winminwidth' to set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7271 the minimal width for other windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7272
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7273 *'wrap'* *'nowrap'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7274 'wrap' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7275 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7276 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7277 This option changes how text is displayed. It doesn't change the text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7278 in the buffer, see 'textwidth' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7279 When on, lines longer than the width of the window will wrap and
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7280 displaying continues on the next line. When off lines will not wrap
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7281 and only part of long lines will be displayed. When the cursor is
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7282 moved to a part that is not shown, the screen will scroll
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7283 horizontally.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7284 The line will be broken in the middle of a word if necessary. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7285 'linebreak' to get the break at a word boundary.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7286 To make scrolling horizontally a bit more useful, try this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7287 :set sidescroll=5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7288 :set listchars+=precedes:<,extends:>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7289 < See 'sidescroll', 'listchars' and |wrap-off|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7290
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7291 *'wrapmargin'* *'wm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7292 'wrapmargin' 'wm' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7293 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7294 Number of characters from the right window border where wrapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7295 starts. When typing text beyond this limit, an <EOL> will be inserted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7296 and inserting continues on the next line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7297 Options that add a margin, such as 'number' and 'foldcolumn', cause
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7298 the text width to be further reduced. This is Vi compatible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7299 When 'textwidth' is non-zero, this option is not used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7300 See also 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|. {Vi: works differently
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7301 and less usefully}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7302
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7303 *'wrapscan'* *'ws'* *'nowrapscan'* *'nows'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7304 'wrapscan' 'ws' boolean (default on) *E384* *E385*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7305 global
500
4772a5e3f9fa updated for version 7.0138
vimboss
parents: 493
diff changeset
7306 Searches wrap around the end of the file. Also applies to |]s| and
4772a5e3f9fa updated for version 7.0138
vimboss
parents: 493
diff changeset
7307 |[s|, searching for spelling mistakes.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7308
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7309 *'write'* *'nowrite'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7310 'write' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7311 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7312 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7313 Allows writing files. When not set, writing a file is not allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7314 Can be used for a view-only mode, where modifications to the text are
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7315 still allowed. Can be reset with the |-m| or |-M| command line
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7316 argument. Filtering text is still possible, even though this requires
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7317 writing a temporary file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7318
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7319 *'writeany'* *'wa'* *'nowriteany'* *'nowa'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7320 'writeany' 'wa' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7321 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7322 Allows writing to any file with no need for "!" override.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7323
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7324 *'writebackup'* *'wb'* *'nowritebackup'* *'nowb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7325 'writebackup' 'wb' boolean (default on with |+writebackup| feature, off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7326 otherwise)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7327 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7328 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7329 Make a backup before overwriting a file. The backup is removed after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7330 the file was successfully written, unless the 'backup' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7331 also on. Reset this option if your file system is almost full. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7332 |backup-table| for another explanation.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7333 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7334 NOTE: This option is set to the default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7335 set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7336
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7337 *'writedelay'* *'wd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7338 'writedelay' 'wd' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7339 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7340 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7341 The number of microseconds to wait for each character sent to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7342 screen. When non-zero, characters are sent to the terminal one by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7343 one. For MS-DOS pcterm this does not work. For debugging purposes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7344
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7345 vim:tw=78:ts=8:ft=help:norl: